6ad19e1e892bd64652921119d0b0747d5ef4aab8
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534
535 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
536 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
537 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
538 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
539 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
540 @end itemize
541
542 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
543
544 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
545 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
546 these on the market.
547
548 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
549 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
550 of USB-based ones.
551
552 @itemize @bullet
553
554 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
555 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
556
557 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
558 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
559 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
560
561 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
562 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
563
564 @item @b{Wiggler2}
565 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
566
567 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
568 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
569
570 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
571 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
572
573 @item @b{arm-jtag}
574 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
575
576 @item @b{chameleon}
577 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
578
579 @item @b{Triton}
580 @* Unknown.
581
582 @item @b{Lattice}
583 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
584 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
585
586 @item @b{flashlink}
587 @* From STMicroelectronics;
588 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
589
590 @end itemize
591
592 @section Other...
593 @itemize @bullet
594
595 @item @b{ep93xx}
596 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
597
598 @item @b{at91rm9200}
599 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
600
601 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
602 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
603
604 @item @b{imx_gpio}
605 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
606
607 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
608 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
609 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
610
611 @end itemize
612
613 @node About Jim-Tcl
614 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
615 @cindex Jim-Tcl
616 @cindex tcl
617
618 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
619 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
620 command interpreter.
621
622 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
623 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
624 much of anything about Tcl.
625 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
626
627 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
628 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
629 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
630 OpenOCD mailing list.
631
632 @itemize @bullet
633 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
634 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
635 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
636 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
637 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
638 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
639
640 @item @b{Missing Features}
641 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
642 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
643 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
644 enabled in OpenOCD.
645
646 @item @b{Scripts}
647 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
648 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
649 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
650
651 @item @b{Commands}
652 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
653 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
654 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
655 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
656
657 @item @b{Historical Note}
658 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
659 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
660 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
661 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
662
663 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
664 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
665 @end itemize
666
667 @node Running
668 @chapter Running
669 @cindex command line options
670 @cindex logfile
671 @cindex directory search
672
673 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
674 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
675 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
676 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
677 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
678 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
679 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
680
681 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
682 tell it how each debug session should work.
683 The @option{--help} option shows:
684 @verbatim
685 bash$ openocd --help
686
687 --help | -h display this help
688 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
689 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
690 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
691 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
692 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
693 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
694 --command | -c run <command>
695 @end verbatim
696
697 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
698 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
699 To specify one or more different
700 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
701
702 @example
703 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
704 @end example
705
706 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
707 @enumerate
708 @item the current directory,
709 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
710 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
712 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
713 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
714 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
715 @end enumerate
716 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
717
718 @quotation Note
719 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
720 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
721 @end quotation
722
723 @section Simple setup, no customization
724
725 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
726 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
727 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
728 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
729 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
730
731 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
732 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
733 the server with some variation of one of the following:
734
735 @example
736 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
738 @end example
739
740 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
741 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
742 If all goes well you'll see output something like
743
744 @example
745 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
746 For bug reports, read
747 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
748 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
749 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
750 @end example
751
752 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
753 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
754 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
755
756 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
757
758 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
759 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
760 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
761 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
762 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
763 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
764 ensure that this always succeeds.
765 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
766 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
767 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
768 and then shut down without acting as a server.
769
770 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
771 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
772 those channels.
773
774 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
775 the @option{-d} option.
776
777 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
778 @option{-c} command line switch.
779
780 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
781 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
782 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
783 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
784 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
785 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
786 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
787
788 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
789 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
790
791 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
792 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
793 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
794 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
795
796 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
797 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
798
799 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
800 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
801 and start the OpenOCD server.
802 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
803 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
804 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
805 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
806
807 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
808
809 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
810 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
811 and a USB cable on the other.
812 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
813 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
814
815 @enumerate
816 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
817 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
818 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
819 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
820 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
821 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
822 debugging host.
823
824 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
825 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
826 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
827 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
828 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
829
830 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
831 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
832 with 1.2 Volt boards.
833
834 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
835 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
836 ways to connect the cable.
837 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
838 Be sure it's firmly connected.
839
840 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
841 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
842 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
843 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
844 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
845 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
846 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
847 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
848
849 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
850 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
851 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
852 but are tedious to set up.
853 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
854 adapter signals to the right board pins.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
857 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
858 you are using to run OpenOCD.
859 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
860
861 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
862 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
863 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
864 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
865
866 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
867 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
868 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
869
870 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
871 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
872 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
873 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
874
875 @end enumerate
876
877 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
878 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
879 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
880
881 @section Project Directory
882
883 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
884
885 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
886 single directory for your work with a given board.
887 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
888 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
889 files accessed through semihosting,
890 and for code you upload to the target board.
891 It is also the natural place to write files,
892 such as log files and data you download from the board.
893
894 @section Configuration Basics
895
896 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
897 a variety of ways you can mix them.
898 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
899
900 @itemize
901 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
902 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
903 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
904 @end itemize
905
906 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
907 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
908 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
909
910 @example
911 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
912
913 # GDB can also flash my flash!
914 gdb_memory_map enable
915 gdb_flash_program enable
916
917 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
918 @end example
919
920 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
921
922 @example
923 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
924 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
925 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
926 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
927 @end example
928
929 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
930 each supporting a different development task.
931 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
932 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
933
934 @quotation Important
935 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
936 problems with how it treats variables.
937 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
938 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
939 that can be tested in a later script.
940 @end quotation
941
942 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
943 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
944 to simplify your work.
945
946 @section User Config Files
947 @cindex config file, user
948 @cindex user config file
949 @cindex config file, overview
950
951 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
952 in one place.
953 One of the following will match your situation best:
954
955 @itemize
956 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
957 provided by someone else.
958 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
959 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
960 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
961 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
962 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
963 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
964
965 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
966 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
967
968 @enumerate
969 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
970 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
971 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
972 @end enumerate
973
974 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
975 The first is an interface config file.
976 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
977 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
978 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
979 meet your deadline:
980
981 @example
982 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
983 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
984 @end example
985
986 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
987 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
988 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
989 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
990
991 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
992 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
993 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
994 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
995 target and board
996 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
997 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
998
999 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1000 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1001 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1002 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1003
1004 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1005 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1006 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1007 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1008 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1009
1010 @quotation Note
1011 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1012 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1013 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1014 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1015 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1016 @end quotation
1017
1018 @item
1019 You may may need to write some C code.
1020 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1021 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1022 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1023 a new chip architecture.
1024 @end itemize
1025
1026 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1027 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1028 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1029
1030 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1031 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1032 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1033 @itemize
1034
1035 @item
1036 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1037 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1038 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1039 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1040
1041 @item
1042 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1043 @cindex vector_catch
1044 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1045 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1046 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1047 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1048 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1049 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1050
1051 @item
1052 You might need to override some defaults.
1053 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1054 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1055
1056 @item
1057 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1058 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1059 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1060 @end itemize
1061
1062 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1063
1064 A few project-specific utility
1065 routines may well speed up your work.
1066 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1067
1068 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1069 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1070 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1071 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1072 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1073 may help:
1074
1075 @example
1076 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1077 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1078 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1079 # Leave the CPU halted.
1080 reset init
1081
1082 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1083 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1084
1085 # Start running.
1086 resume 0x20000000
1087 @}
1088 @end example
1089
1090 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1091 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1092 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1093 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1094 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1095
1096 @example
1097 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1098 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1099 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1100 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1101 reset init
1102
1103 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1104 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1105 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1106 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1107 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1108 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1109 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1110
1111 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1112 reset run
1113 @}
1114 @end example
1115
1116 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1117 from NAND.
1118 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1119 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1120 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1121
1122 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1123 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1124
1125 @section Target Software Changes
1126
1127 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1128 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1129 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1130 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1131 handling issues like:
1132
1133 @itemize @bullet
1134
1135 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1136 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1137 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1138 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1139 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1140 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1141 your debug sessions.
1142
1143 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1144 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1145 That might however be your only option.
1146
1147 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1148 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1149 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1150 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1151 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1152 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1153 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1154 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1155 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1156 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1157 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1158 instead of the whole thing.
1159 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1160 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1161
1162 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1163 @cindex ARM semihosting
1164 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1165 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1166 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1167 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1168 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1169 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1170 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1171 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1172 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1173 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1174 NAND or SPI flash.
1175
1176 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1177 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1178 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1179 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1180 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1181
1182 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1183 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1184 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1185 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1186 registers which can be used to change various features including
1187 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1188 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1189 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1190 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1191 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1192
1193 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1194 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1195 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1196 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1197 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1198
1199 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1200 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1201 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1202 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1203 early code execution can be debugged
1204 or firmware can be replaced.
1205
1206 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1207 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1208 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1209 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1210 operations like writing to memory.)
1211
1212 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1213 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1214 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1215 various kinds of message.
1216 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1217
1218 @end itemize
1219
1220 @section Target Hardware Setup
1221
1222 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1223 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1224 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1225 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1226 working with.}
1227
1228 Common issues include:
1229
1230 @itemize @bullet
1231
1232 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1233 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1234 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1235 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1236 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1237 or one from a daughtercard).
1238 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1239 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1240
1241 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1242 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1243 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1244 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1245 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1246 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1247
1248 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1249 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1250 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1251 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1252 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1253
1254
1255 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1256 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1257 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1258 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1259 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1260 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1261 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1262
1263 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1264 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1265 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1266 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1267 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1268
1269 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1270 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1271 used to start booting.
1272
1273 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1274 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1275 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1276 multiple audio codec chips).
1277 This interacts with software
1278 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1279 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1280 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1281 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1282 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1283 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1284 audio or video codecs are used.
1285
1286 @end itemize
1287
1288 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1289 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1290 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1291 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1292 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1293 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1294 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1295 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1296 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1297 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1298
1299
1300 @node Config File Guidelines
1301 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1302
1303 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1304 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1305 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1306 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1307
1308 You should find the following directories under
1309 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1310 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1311 @itemize @bullet
1312 @item @file{interface} ...
1313 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1314 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1315 @item @file{board} ...
1316 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1317 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1318
1319 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1320 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1321 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1322 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1323 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1324 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1325 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1326 a CPU and an FPGA.
1327 @item @file{target} ...
1328 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1329 on a chip
1330 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1331 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1332 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1333 the target config file defines all of them.
1334 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1335 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1336 @end itemize
1337
1338 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1339 file may override features in any of the above files by
1340 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1341 commands specific to their situation.
1342
1343 @section Interface Config Files
1344
1345 The user config file
1346 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1347
1348 @example
1349 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1350 @end example
1351
1352 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1353 in use today with OpenOCD.
1354 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1355 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1356
1357 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1358 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1359 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1360 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1361 and need to provide a driver for it.
1362
1363 @section Board Config Files
1364 @cindex config file, board
1365 @cindex board config file
1366
1367 The user config file
1368 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1369
1370 @example
1371 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1372 @end example
1373
1374 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1375 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1376 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1377
1378 @enumerate
1379 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1380 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1381 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1382 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1383 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1384 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1385 @end enumerate
1386
1387 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1388 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1389 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1390 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1391
1392 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1393 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1394 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1395 configuration works.
1396
1397 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1398
1399 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1400 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1401 convention on how to use certain variables.
1402
1403 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1404 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1405 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1406 used at will within a target configuration file.
1407
1408 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1409 for a board with three chips:
1410
1411 @example
1412 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1413 set CHIPNAME network
1414 set ENDIAN big
1415 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1416 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1417 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1418 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1419
1420 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1421 set CHIPNAME video
1422 set ENDIAN little
1423 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1424 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1425 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1426 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1427
1428 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1429 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1430 unset ENDIAN
1431 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1432 @end example
1433
1434 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1435 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1436 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1437 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1438 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1439 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1440 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1441 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1442
1443 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1444 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1445 naming collisions.
1446
1447 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1448 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1449 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1450 up other clocks and peripherals.
1451
1452 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1453 @cindex variable names
1454
1455 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1456 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1457 one such chip (as shown above).
1458 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1459 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1460 to promote consistency and
1461 so that board files can override target defaults.
1462
1463 Inputs to target config files include:
1464
1465 @itemize @bullet
1466 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1467 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1468 tap identifier dotted names.
1469 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1470 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1471 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1472 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1473 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1474 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1475 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1476 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1477 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1478 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1479 @end itemize
1480
1481 Outputs from target config files include:
1482
1483 @itemize @bullet
1484 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1485 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1486 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1487 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1488 specific to that board and that target.
1489 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1490 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1491 @end itemize
1492
1493 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1494 @cindex event, reset-init
1495 @cindex reset-init handler
1496
1497 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1498 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1499 fully set up yet.
1500 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1501 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1502 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1503 handler is one of the most important.
1504
1505 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1506 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1507 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1508 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1509 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1510
1511 @quotation Note
1512 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1513 are included here.
1514 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1515 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1516 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1517 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1518 @end quotation
1519
1520 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1521 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1522 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1523 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1524 those as parameters.
1525 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1526 and disabling the watchdog.
1527 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1528 the next developer doing such work.
1529 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1530
1531 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1532 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1533 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1534 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1535
1536 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1537
1538 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1539 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1540 a low JTAG clock rate.
1541 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1542 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1543 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1544 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1545 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1546 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1547 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1548
1549 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1550 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1551 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1552 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1553 which might be less than that.
1554
1555 @quotation Warning
1556 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1557 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1558 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1559 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1560 @end quotation
1561
1562 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1563 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1564 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1565 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1566 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1567 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1568
1569 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1570 @subsection The init_board procedure
1571 @cindex init_board procedure
1572
1573 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1574 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1575 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1576 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1577 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1578 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1579 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1580 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1581 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1582 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1583 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1584 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1585
1586 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1587 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1588
1589 @example
1590 ### board_file.cfg ###
1591
1592 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1593 source [find target/target.cfg]
1594
1595 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1596 # enables fast on-board clock source
1597 # configures the chip to use it
1598 @}
1599
1600 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1601 proc init_board @{@} @{
1602 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1603
1604 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1605 adapter_khz 100
1606 @}
1607
1608 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1609 enable_fast_clock
1610 adapter_khz 10000
1611 @}
1612 @}
1613 @end example
1614
1615 @section Target Config Files
1616 @cindex config file, target
1617 @cindex target config file
1618
1619 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1620 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1621 more target config files like this:
1622
1623 @example
1624 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1625 @end example
1626
1627 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1628 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1629 In summary the target files should contain
1630
1631 @enumerate
1632 @item Set defaults
1633 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1634 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1635 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1636 @item On-Chip flash
1637 @end enumerate
1638
1639 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1640 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1641 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1642
1643 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1644 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1645 can talk to the chip.
1646 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1647 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1648 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1649 and other processing engines.
1650
1651 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1652
1653 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1654 letting board config files express environment-specific
1655 differences in how things should be set up.
1656
1657 @example
1658 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1659 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1660 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1661 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1662 @} else @{
1663 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1664 @}
1665
1666 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1667 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1668 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1669 @} else @{
1670 set _ENDIAN little
1671 @}
1672
1673 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1674 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1675 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1676 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1677 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1680 @}
1681 @end example
1682 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1683
1684 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1685 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1686 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1687
1688 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1689 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1690 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1691
1692 @example
1693 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1694 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1695 @end example
1696
1697 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1698 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1699 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1700 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1701 for taps.
1702
1703 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1704 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1705 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1706 looks (in part) like this:
1707
1708 @example
1709 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1710 @end example
1711
1712 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1713 to source such a config file twice, with different
1714 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1715 it adds a different TAP each time.
1716
1717 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1718 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1719 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1720 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1721
1722 @example
1723 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1724 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1725 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1726 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1727 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1728 @end example
1729
1730 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1731 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1732
1733 @itemize
1734 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1735 plus a JRC to enable them
1736 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1737 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1738 is not currently used)
1739 @end itemize
1740
1741 @subsection Add CPU targets
1742
1743 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1744 GDB and other commands can use it.
1745 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1746 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1747 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1748 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1749
1750 @example
1751 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1752 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1753 @end example
1754
1755 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1756 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1757 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1758 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1759 a work area if you can.
1760 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1761
1762 @example
1763 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1764 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1765 @end example
1766
1767 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1768 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1769 @cindex SMP
1770 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1771
1772 @example
1773 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1774 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1775 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1776 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1777 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1778 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1779 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1780 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1781 @end example
1782 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1783 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1784 @itemize @bullet
1785 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1786 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1787 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1788 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1789 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1790 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1791 @end itemize
1792
1793 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1794 command have been implemented.
1795 @itemize @bullet
1796 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1797 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1798 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1799 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} init
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2133 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2134
2135 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2136 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2137 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2138
2139 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2140 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2143 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2144 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2145 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2146 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2147 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2148
2149 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2150 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2151 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2152 @end deffn
2153
2154 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2155 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2156 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2157 output from the Tcl engine.
2158 Intended as a machine interface.
2159 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2160 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2161 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2162 @end deffn
2163
2164 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2165 Specify or query the
2166 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2167 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2168 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2169 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2170 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2174 @section GDB Configuration
2175 @cindex GDB
2176 @cindex GDB configuration
2177 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2178 The ones listed here are static and global.
2179 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2180 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2181
2182 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2183 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2184 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2185 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2186 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2187 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2188 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2189 @end deffn
2190
2191 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2192 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2193 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2194 vFlash packet is received.
2195 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2196 @end deffn
2197
2198 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2199 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2200 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2201 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2202 for flash programming to work.
2203 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2204 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2208 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2209 by GDB memory read packets.
2210 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2211 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2212 @end deffn
2213
2214 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2215 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2216 packets report errors or not.
2217 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2218 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2219 @end deffn
2220
2221 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2222 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2223 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2224 @end deffn
2225
2226 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2227 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2228
2229 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2230 @end deffn
2231
2232 @anchor{eventpolling}
2233 @section Event Polling
2234
2235 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2236 where significant events can happen at any time.
2237 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2238 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2239 or to GDB.
2240
2241 Examples of such events include:
2242
2243 @itemize
2244 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2245 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2246 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2247 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2248 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2249 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2250 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2251 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2252 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2253 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2254 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2255 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2256 @end itemize
2257
2258 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2259 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2260 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2261 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2262 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2263
2264 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2265 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2266 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2267 to the various active targets.
2268 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2269 which is normally done in the background.
2270
2271 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2272 Poll the current target for its current state.
2273 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2274 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2275 specific information about the current state is printed.
2276 An optional parameter
2277 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2278
2279 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2280 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2281 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2282 @example
2283 > poll
2284 background polling: on
2285 target state: halted
2286 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2287 current mode: Supervisor
2288 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2289 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2290 >
2291 @end example
2292 @end deffn
2293
2294 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2295 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2296 @cindex config file, interface
2297 @cindex interface config file
2298
2299 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2300 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2301 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2302
2303 @quotation Note
2304 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2305 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2306 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2307 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2308 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2309 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2310 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2311 @end quotation
2312
2313 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2314 through commands in an interface configuration
2315 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2316 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2317
2318 @example
2319 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2320 @end example
2321
2322 These commands tell
2323 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2324 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2325
2326 @example
2327 # jlink interface
2328 interface jlink
2329 @end example
2330
2331 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2332
2333
2334 @section Interface Configuration
2335
2336 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2337 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2338 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2339
2340 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2341 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2342 target.
2343 @end deffn
2344
2345 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2346 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2347 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2348 @end deffn
2349 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2350 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2351 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2352 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2353 the hardware can support.
2354 @end deffn
2355
2356
2357
2358 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2359 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2360 @end deffn
2361
2362 @section Interface Drivers
2363
2364 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2365 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2366 available at run time.
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2369 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2370 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2371 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2372
2373 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2374 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2375 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2376 @end deffn
2377
2378 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2379 Displays status of RTCK option.
2380 Optionally sets that option first.
2381 @end deffn
2382 @end deffn
2383
2384 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2385 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2386 This has one driver-specific command:
2387
2388 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2389 Logs some status
2390 @end deffn
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2394 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2395 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2396 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2397 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2398 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2402 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2403
2404 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2405 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2406 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2407 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2408 @example
2409 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2410 @end example
2411 @end deffn
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2414 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2415 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2419 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2420 @end deffn
2421 @end deffn
2422
2423 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2424 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2428 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2432 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2433 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2434
2435 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2436 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2437
2438 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2439 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2440
2441 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2442 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2443 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2444 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2445 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2446 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2447
2448 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2449 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2450 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2451 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2452 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2453
2454 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2455 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2456 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2457 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2458
2459 @itemize @minus
2460 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2461 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2462 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2463 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2464 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2465 switching data and direction as necessary
2466 @end itemize
2467
2468 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2469 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2470
2471 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2472 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2473 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2474 @example
2475 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2476 @end example
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2480 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2481 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2482 during device selection.
2483 @end deffn
2484
2485 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2486 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2487 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2488 is connected to the host.
2489 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2490 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2491 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2492 @end deffn
2493
2494 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2495 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2496 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2497 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2498 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2499 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2500
2501 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2502 @end deffn
2503
2504 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2505 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2506 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2510 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2511 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2512 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2513 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2514 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2515 and initially asserted reset signals.
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2519 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2520 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2521 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2522 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2523 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2524 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2525 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2526 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2527 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2528 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2529
2530 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2531 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2532 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2533 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2534 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2535 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2536
2537 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2538 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2539 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2540 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2541 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2542 are always driven by the FTDI.
2543
2544 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2545 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2546 @var{name}.
2547 @end deffn
2548
2549 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2550 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2551 @itemize @minus
2552 @item @option{0}, drive low
2553 @item @option{1}, drive high
2554 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2555 @end itemize
2556 @end deffn
2557
2558 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2559 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2563 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2564
2565 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2566 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2567 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2568 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2569 @itemize @minus
2570 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2571 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2572 @end itemize
2573 @end deffn
2574
2575 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2576 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2577
2578 @end deffn
2579
2580 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2581 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2582 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2583 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2584
2585 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2586 @itemize @minus
2587 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2588 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2589 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2590 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2591 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2592 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2593 @end itemize
2594
2595 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2596 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2597 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2598 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2599 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2600 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2601 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2602 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2603
2604 FT232R
2605 @itemize @minus
2606 @item bit 7 - RI
2607 @item bit 6 - DCD
2608 @item bit 5 - DSR
2609 @item bit 4 - DTR
2610 @item bit 3 - CTS
2611 @item bit 2 - RTS
2612 @item bit 1 - RXD
2613 @item bit 0 - TXD
2614 @end itemize
2615
2616 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2617 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2618
2619 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2620 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2621 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2622 @end deffn
2623
2624 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2625 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2626 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2627 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2631 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2632 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2636 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2637 @end deffn
2638
2639 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2640 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2644 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2645 @end deffn
2646
2647 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2648 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2649 @end deffn
2650
2651 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2652 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2656 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2660 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2661 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2662 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2663 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2664 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2665 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2666 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2667 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2668 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @end deffn
2672
2673 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2674 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2675 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2676 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2677
2678 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2679 processors which are being simulated.
2680
2681 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2682 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2683 sockets instead of TCP.
2684 @end deffn
2685
2686 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2687 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2688 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2689 @end deffn
2690
2691 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2692 something like:
2693
2694 @example
2695 interface remote_bitbang
2696 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2697 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2698 @end example
2699
2700 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2701 named mysocket:
2702
2703 @example
2704 interface remote_bitbang
2705 remote_bitbang_port 0
2706 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2707 @end example
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2711 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2712 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2713 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2714
2715 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2716 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2717 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2718 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2719 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2720 @end deffn
2721
2722 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2723 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2724 default values are used.
2725 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2726 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2727 @example
2728 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2729 @end example
2730 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2731 @example
2732 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2733 @end example
2734 @end deffn
2735
2736 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2737 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2738 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2739 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2740 target board.
2741
2742 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2743 @example
2744 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2745 reset_config srst_only
2746 @end example
2747 @end deffn
2748
2749 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2750 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2751 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2752 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2753 @end deffn
2754
2755 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2756 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2757 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @end deffn
2761
2762 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2763 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2764 This has one driver-specific command:
2765
2766 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2767 Display either the address of the I/O port
2768 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2769 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2770 This is a write-once setting.
2771 @end deffn
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2775 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2776 transports.
2777
2778 @quotation Compatibility Note
2779 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2780 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2781 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2782 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2783 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2784 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2785 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2786 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2787 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2788 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2789 @end quotation
2790
2791 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2792 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2793 states.
2794 @end deffn
2795 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2796 Display free device internal memory.
2797 @end deffn
2798 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2799 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2800 command version.
2801 @end deffn
2802 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2803 Display the device configuration.
2804 @end deffn
2805 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2806 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2807 power state.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2810 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2811 @end deffn
2812 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2813 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2814 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2815 IP configuration.
2816 @end deffn
2817 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2818 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2819 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2822 Reset the current configuration.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2825 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2828 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2829 pairs.
2830
2831 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2832 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2833 @example
2834 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2835 @end example
2836 @end deffn
2837 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2838 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2839 pairs.
2840
2841 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2842 @example
2843 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2844 77a90000
2845 @end example
2846 @end deffn
2847 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2848 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2849 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2850 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2851 instead.
2852
2853 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2854 @end deffn
2855 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2856 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2857 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2858
2859 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2860 @end deffn
2861 @end deffn
2862
2863 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2864 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2865 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2866 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2867 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2868 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2869 configuration script.
2870
2871 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2872 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2873 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2874 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2875 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2876
2877 Known limitations:
2878 @itemize @bullet
2879 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2880 and 2.7 MHz.
2881 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2882 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2883 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2884 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2885 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2886 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2887 communications with the target.
2888 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2889 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2890 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2891 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2892 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2893 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2894 @end itemize
2895
2896 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2897 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2898 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2899 @end deffn
2900
2901 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2902 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2903 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2904 @end deffn
2905
2906 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2907 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2908 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2909 target as a side-effect.
2910 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2911 @end deffn
2912
2913 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2914 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2915 version, and target voltage.
2916 @end deffn
2917 @end deffn
2918
2919 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2920 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2921 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2922 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2923 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2926 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2927 This is a write-once setting.
2928 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2929
2930 @itemize @minus
2931 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2932 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2933 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2934 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2935 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2936 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2937 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2938 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2939 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2940 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2941 some versions of
2942 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2943 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2944 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2945 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2946 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2947 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2948 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2949 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2950 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2951 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2952 @end itemize
2953 @end deffn
2954
2955 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2956 Display either the address of the I/O port
2957 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2958 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2959 This is a write-once setting.
2960
2961 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2962 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2963 you may encounter a problem.
2964 @end deffn
2965
2966 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2967 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2968 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2969 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2970 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2971 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2972
2973 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2974 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2975 @quotation Tip
2976 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2977 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2978 @example
2979 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2980 > adapter_khz 500
2981 @end example
2982 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2983 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2984 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2985 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2986 large set of samples.
2987 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2988 @example
2989 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2990 @end example
2991 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2992 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2993
2994 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2995 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2996 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2997 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2998 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2999 @end quotation
3000 @end deffn
3001
3002 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3003 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3004 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3005 @end deffn
3006
3007 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3008 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3009
3010 @example
3011 interface parport
3012 parport_port 0x278
3013 parport_cable wiggler
3014 @end example
3015 @end deffn
3016
3017 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3018 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3019 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3020 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3021 @end deffn
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3025 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3026 @end deffn
3027
3028 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3029 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3030 @end deffn
3031
3032 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3033 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3034
3035 @quotation Note
3036 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3037 which are not currently documented here.
3038 @end quotation
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @anchor{hla_interface}
3042 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3043 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3044 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3045 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3046
3047 Currently supported adapters include the ST ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3048 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3049 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3050 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3051 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3052
3053 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3054 Currently Not Supported.
3055 @end deffn
3056
3057 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3058 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3062 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3066 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3067 @end deffn
3068
3069 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3070 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3071 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3072 @end deffn
3073 @end deffn
3074
3075 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3076 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3077 @end deffn
3078
3079 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3080 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3084 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3085 @end deffn
3086
3087 @quotation Note
3088 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3089 which are not currently documented here.
3090 @end quotation
3091
3092 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3093 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3094 No arguments: print status.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3098 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3099 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3100
3101 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3102 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3103 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3104 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3105 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3106 configuration on exit.
3107
3108 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3109 pinout.
3110
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3114 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3115 of the one which is most popular.
3116
3117 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3118
3119 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3120 pinout.
3121
3122 @end deffn
3123
3124
3125 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3126 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3127 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3128
3129 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3130 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3131 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3132
3133 @itemize @minus
3134 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3135 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3136 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3137 @end itemize
3138 @end deffn
3139
3140 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3141 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3142 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3143 @end deffn
3144 @end deffn
3145
3146 @section Transport Configuration
3147 @cindex Transport
3148 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3149 and the debug adapter you are using,
3150 several transports may be available to
3151 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3152 @deffn Command {transport list}
3153 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3154 version of OpenOCD.
3155 @end deffn
3156
3157 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3158 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3159
3160 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3161 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3162 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3163 adapter's driver).
3164
3165 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3166 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3167 supported by the debug adapter.
3168
3169 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3170 transport, if any.
3171 @end deffn
3172
3173 @subsection JTAG Transport
3174 @cindex JTAG
3175 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3176 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3177 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3178 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3179 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3180 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3181
3182 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3183 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3184 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3185 hla_jtag}.
3186
3187 @subsection SWD Transport
3188 @cindex SWD
3189 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3190 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3191 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3192 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3193 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3194 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3195 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3196
3197 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3198 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3199 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3200 hla_swd}.
3201
3202 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3203 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3204 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3205 expected to change.
3206 @end deffn
3207 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3208 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3209 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3210 No parameters: displays current settings.
3211 @end deffn
3212
3213 @subsection SPI Transport
3214 @cindex SPI
3215 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3216 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3217 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3218 solution for flash programming.
3219
3220 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3221 @section JTAG Speed
3222 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3223 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3224 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3225 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3226 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3227 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3228 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3229 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3230 power management software that may be active.
3231
3232 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3233 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3234 target event handler.
3235 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3236 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3237 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3238 sets up those clocks).
3239 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3240 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3241 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3242 in the target config file.
3243 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3244 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3245 config file instead.
3246 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3247 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3248 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3249
3250 @example
3251 jtag_rclk 3000
3252 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3253 @end example
3254
3255 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3256 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3257 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3258 may not be the fastest solution.
3259
3260 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3261 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3262 which support adaptive clocking.
3263
3264 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3265 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3266 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3267 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3268 than the speed specified.
3269
3270 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3271 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3272 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3273 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3274
3275 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3276 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3277 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3278 JTAG clocking after setup.
3279 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3280 If the interface device can not
3281 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3282 @end deffn
3283
3284 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3285 @cindex adaptive clocking
3286 @cindex RTCK
3287 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3288 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3289 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3290 @example
3291 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3292 jtag_rclk 3000
3293 @end example
3294 @end defun
3295
3296 @node Reset Configuration
3297 @chapter Reset Configuration
3298 @cindex Reset Configuration
3299
3300 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3301 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3302 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3303 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3304 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3305 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3306 Please see the various board files for examples.
3307
3308 @quotation Note
3309 To maintainers and integrators:
3310 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3311 Normally the board configuration file
3312 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3313 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3314
3315 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3316 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3317 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3318 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3319 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3320 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3321 @end quotation
3322
3323 @section Types of Reset
3324
3325 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3326 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3327 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3328
3329 @itemize @bullet
3330 @item
3331 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3332 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3333 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3334 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3335 @item
3336 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3337 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3338 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3339 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3340 @item
3341 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3342 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3343 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3344 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3345 @item
3346 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3347 several other types of reset.
3348 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3349 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3350 There may be individual module resets.
3351 @end itemize
3352
3353 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3354 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3355 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3356 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3357 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3358 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3359 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3360 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3361 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3362
3363 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3364 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3365
3366 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3367 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3368 common issues are:
3369
3370 @itemize @bullet
3371
3372 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3373 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3374 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3375 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3376 when either of those signals is not connected.
3377 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3378 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3379 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3380 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3381
3382 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3383 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3384 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3385 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3386
3387 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3388 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3389 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3390 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3391 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3392 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3393 hardware debouncing.
3394 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3395 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3396
3397 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3398 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3399 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3400 to use push/pull output drivers.
3401 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3402 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3403 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3404 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3405
3406 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3407 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3408 issues (not limited to errata).
3409 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3410 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3411 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3412 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3413 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3414 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3415 @end itemize
3416
3417 There can also be other issues.
3418 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3419 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3420 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3421 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3422 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3423 Agreement (NDA).
3424
3425 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3426 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3427 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3428
3429 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3430 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3431
3432 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3433
3434 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3435 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3436 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3437 allowing it to be deasserted.
3438 @end deffn
3439
3440 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3441 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3442 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3443 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3444 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3445 @end deffn
3446
3447 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3448 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3449 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3450 allowing it to be deasserted.
3451 @end deffn
3452
3453 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3454 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3455 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3456 @end deffn
3457
3458 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3459 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3460 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3461 configuration scripts.
3462
3463 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3464 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3465 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3466 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3467 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3468 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3469 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3470 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3471
3472 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3473 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3474 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3475 -- may be specified at a time.
3476 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3477 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3478 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3479 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3480 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3481
3482 @itemize
3483 @item
3484 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3485 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3486 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3487 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3488 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3489
3490 @quotation Tip
3491 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3492 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3493 @end quotation
3494
3495 @item
3496 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3497 signal implementations.
3498 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3499 indicating everything behaves normally.
3500 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3501 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3502 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3503 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3504 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3505 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3506 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3507
3508 @item
3509 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3510 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3511 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3512 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3513 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3514 while SRST is asserted.
3515 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3516 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3517
3518 @item
3519 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3520 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3521 is required to use this option.
3522 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3523 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3524 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3525 be asserted before any target connection.
3526 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3527 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3528 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3529 @end itemize
3530
3531 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3532 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3533 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3534 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3535 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3536
3537 @itemize
3538 @item
3539 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3540 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3541 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3542 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3543
3544 @item
3545 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3546 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3547 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3548 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3549 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3550 @end itemize
3551 @end deffn
3552
3553 @section Custom Reset Handling
3554 @cindex events
3555
3556 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3557 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3558 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3559 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3560 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3561 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3562
3563 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3564 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3565 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3566 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3567 want to reset everything at once.
3568
3569 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3570 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3571 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3572 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3573 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3574 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3575 needs special attention.
3576
3577 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3578 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3579 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3580 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3581 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3582 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3583 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3584 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3585
3586 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3587 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3588 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3589 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3590 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3591
3592 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3593 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3594 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3595 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3596 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3597 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3598 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3599 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3600 or potentially some other value.
3601
3602 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3603 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3604 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3605 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3606 (or their associated targets)
3607 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3608
3609 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3610 they return.
3611 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3612 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3613 @end deffn
3614
3615 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3616 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3617 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3618 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3619 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3620 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3621 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3622 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3623 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3624 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3625 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3626 @end deffn
3627
3628 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3629 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3630 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3631 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3632 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3633 @end deffn
3634
3635
3636 @node TAP Declaration
3637 @chapter TAP Declaration
3638 @cindex TAP declaration
3639 @cindex TAP configuration
3640
3641 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3642 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3643
3644 @itemize @bullet
3645 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3646 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3647 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3648 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3649 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3650 start running that code.
3651 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3652 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3653 and missing connections.
3654 @end itemize
3655
3656 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3657 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3658 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3659 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3660 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3661
3662 @section Scan Chains
3663 @cindex scan chain
3664
3665 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3666 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3667 They also need to be added to
3668 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3669 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3670 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3671 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3672 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3673 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3674 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3675 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3676
3677 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3678 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3679 command, presented in the next chapter.
3680 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3681 debugging targets.)
3682 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3683
3684 @verbatim
3685 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3686 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3687 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3688 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3689 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3690 @end verbatim
3691
3692 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3693 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3694 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3695 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3696 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3697 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3698 until they are told to do so.
3699
3700 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3701 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3702 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3703 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3704
3705 @example
3706 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3707 @end example
3708
3709 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3710 by a given chip.
3711 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3712 and so forth.
3713 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3714 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3715 both inside a single chip and between them.
3716 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3717
3718 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3719 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3720 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3721 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3722 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3723 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3724 includes commands something like this:
3725
3726 @example
3727 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3728 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3729 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3730 @end example
3731
3732 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3733 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3734 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3735
3736 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3737 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3738 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3739 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3740 @example
3741 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3742 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3743 @}
3744 @end example
3745 @end deffn
3746
3747 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3748 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3749 and their status.
3750 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3751 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3752 but systems with a JTAG router can
3753 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3754 @end deffn
3755
3756 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3757 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3758
3759 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3760 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3761
3762 @section TAP Names
3763 @cindex dotted name
3764
3765 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3766 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3767 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3768 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3769 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3770 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3771 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3772 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3773
3774 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3775 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3776 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3777
3778 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3779
3780 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3781 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3782 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3783 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3784
3785 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3786 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3787 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3788 overridable.
3789
3790 @cindex TAP naming convention
3791 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3792 and should follow this convention:
3793
3794 @itemize @bullet
3795 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3796 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3797 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3798 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3799 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3800 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3801 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3802 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3803 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3804 with a single TAP;
3805 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3806 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3807 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3808 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3809 @end itemize
3810
3811 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3812
3813 @itemize @bullet
3814 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3815 @*The length in bits of the
3816 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3817 @end itemize
3818
3819 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3820
3821 @itemize @bullet
3822 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3823 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3824 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3825 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3826 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3827 (the TAP is linked in).
3828 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3829 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3830 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3831 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3832 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3833 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3834 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3835 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3836 values that were found but not included in the list.
3837
3838 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3839 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3840 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3841 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3842 hardware to find these values.
3843 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3844 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3845 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3846 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3847 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3848 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3849 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3850 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3851 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3852 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3853 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3854 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3855 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3856 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3857 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3858 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3859 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3860 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3861 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3862 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3863 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3864 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3865 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3866 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3867 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3868 @end itemize
3869 @end deffn
3870
3871 @section Other TAP commands
3872
3873 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3874 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3875 At this writing this TAP attribute
3876 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3877 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3878 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3879 See the next section for information about the available events.
3880
3881 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3882 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3883 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3884 @end deffn
3885
3886 @section TAP Events
3887 @cindex events
3888 @cindex TAP events
3889
3890 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3891 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3892 The other applies to debugger targets,
3893 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3894
3895 The TAP events currently defined are:
3896
3897 @itemize @bullet
3898 @item @b{post-reset}
3899 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3900 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3901 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3902 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3903 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3904
3905 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3906 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3907 of any particular target.
3908 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3909 @item @b{setup}
3910 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3911 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3912 @item @b{tap-disable}
3913 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3914 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3915 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3916 @item @b{tap-enable}
3917 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3918 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3919 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3920 @end itemize
3921
3922 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3923 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3924 contents to be accurate), you might:
3925
3926 @example
3927 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3928 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3929 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3930 @}
3931 @end example
3932
3933
3934 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3935 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3936 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3937 @cindex jrc
3938
3939 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3940 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3941 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3942 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3943 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3944
3945 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3946 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3947 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3948 be visible.
3949 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3950 ignores, such as:
3951
3952 @itemize
3953 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3954 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3955 TAPs receive new instructions.
3956 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3957 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3958 @end itemize
3959
3960 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3961 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3962 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3963 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3964
3965 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3966 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3967
3968 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3969 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3970 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3971 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3972 should define TAP event handlers using
3973 code that looks something like this:
3974
3975 @example
3976 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3977 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3978 @}
3979 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3980 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3981 @}
3982 @end example
3983
3984 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3985
3986 @example
3987 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3988 @end example
3989
3990 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3991 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3992 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3993 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3994
3995 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3996 If necessary, disables the tap
3997 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3998 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3999 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4000 and "0" if it is disabled.
4001 @end deffn
4002
4003 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4004 If necessary, enables the tap
4005 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4006 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4007 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4008 and "0" if it is disabled.
4009 @end deffn
4010
4011 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4012 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4013 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4014 and "0" if it is disabled.
4015
4016 @quotation Note
4017 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4018 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4019 @end quotation
4020 @end deffn
4021
4022 @anchor{autoprobing}
4023 @section Autoprobing
4024 @cindex autoprobe
4025 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4026
4027 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4028 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4029 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4030 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4031
4032 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4033 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4034 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4035 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4036 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4037 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4038 right when they come out of reset).
4039
4040 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4041
4042 @example
4043 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4044 reset_config trst_and_srst
4045 jtag_rclk 8
4046 @end example
4047
4048 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4049 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4050
4051 @enumerate
4052 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4053 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4054 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4055 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4056 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4057 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4058 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4059 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4060 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4061 that is discovered.
4062 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4063 register, it will report it.
4064 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4065 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4066 @end enumerate
4067
4068 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4069 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4070 that's a bit more complex:
4071
4072 @example
4073 clock speed 8 kHz
4074 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4075 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4076 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4077 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4078 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4079 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4080 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4081 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4082 @end example
4083
4084 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4085 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4086 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4087 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4088 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4089 and so forth.
4090
4091 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4092 @section DAP declaration (ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4093 @cindex DAP declaration
4094
4095 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4096 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4097 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all
4098 ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4099 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4100
4101 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4102
4103 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4104 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4105 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4106 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4107 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4108
4109 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4110
4111 @itemize @bullet
4112 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4113 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4114 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4115 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4116 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4117 @end itemize
4118 @end deffn
4119
4120 @deffn Command {dap names}
4121 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4122 for TCL scripting.
4123 @end deffn
4124
4125 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4126 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4127 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4128 @end deffn
4129
4130 @deffn Command {dap init}
4131 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4132 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4133 initialization, too.
4134 @end deffn
4135
4136 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4137
4138 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4139 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4140 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4141 @end deffn
4142
4143 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4144 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4145 @end deffn
4146
4147 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4148 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4149 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4150 or set a new value @var{value}.
4151 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4152 @end deffn
4153
4154 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4155 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4156 @end deffn
4157
4158 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4159 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4160 value @var{value}.
4161
4162 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4163 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4164 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4165
4166 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4167 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4168 @end deffn
4169
4170 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4171 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4172 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4173 @end deffn
4174
4175 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4176 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4177 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4178 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4179 @end deffn
4180
4181 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4182 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4183
4184 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4185 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4186 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4187 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4188 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4189 for details.
4190
4191 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4192 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4193 the pattern:
4194 @example
4195 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4196 @end example
4197
4198 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4199 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4200 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4201 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4202 @example
4203 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4204 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4205 @end example
4206
4207 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4208 @example
4209 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4210 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4211 @end example
4212
4213 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4214 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4215
4216 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4217 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4218 example with a proper dap name:
4219 @example
4220 xxx.dap apcsw default
4221 @end example
4222 @end deffn
4223
4224 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4225 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4226 Disabled by default
4227 @end deffn
4228
4229
4230 @node CPU Configuration
4231 @chapter CPU Configuration
4232 @cindex GDB target
4233
4234 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4235 You can also access these targets without GDB
4236 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4237 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4238 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4239 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4240
4241 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4242 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4243
4244 @section Target List
4245 @cindex target, current
4246 @cindex target, list
4247
4248 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4249 where each member has a name.
4250 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4251 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4252 (plural!) command.
4253 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4254 look like with more than one:
4255 @verbatim
4256 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4257 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4258 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4259 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4260 @end verbatim
4261
4262 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4263 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4264 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4265 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4266 space seen by that current target.
4267 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4268 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4269 are examples; and there are many more.
4270
4271 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4272
4273 @deffn Command {target current}
4274 Returns the name of the current target.
4275 @end deffn
4276
4277 @deffn Command {target names}
4278 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4279 @example
4280 foreach t [target names] @{
4281 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4282 @}
4283 @end example
4284 @end deffn
4285
4286 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4287 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4288
4289 @deffn Command targets [name]
4290 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4291 command names are singular.}
4292
4293 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4294 targets in a user friendly form.
4295
4296 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4297 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4298 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4299 @end deffn
4300
4301 @section Target CPU Types
4302 @cindex target type
4303 @cindex CPU type
4304
4305 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4306 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4307 when calling @command{target create}.
4308 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4309 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4310 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4311 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4312 what core-specific commands may be available
4313 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4314 and more.
4315
4316 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4317 since there's a command to list them.
4318
4319 @anchor{targettypes}
4320 @deffn Command {target types}
4321 Lists all supported target types.
4322 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4323
4324 @itemize @bullet
4325 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4326 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4327 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4328 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4329 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4330 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4331 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4332 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4333 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4334 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4335 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4336 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4337 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4338 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4339 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4340 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4341 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4342 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4343 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4344 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4345 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4346 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4347 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4348 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4349 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4350 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4351 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4352 @itemize @minus
4353 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4354 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4355 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4356 @end itemize
4357 And two debug interfaces cores:
4358 @itemize @minus
4359 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4360 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4361 @end itemize
4362 @end itemize
4363 @end deffn
4364
4365 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4366 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4367 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4368 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4369 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4370 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4371 reflect design generations;
4372 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4373 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4374
4375 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4376 @section Target Configuration
4377
4378 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4379 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4380 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4381 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4382 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4383
4384 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4385 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4386 optional parts.
4387 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4388 command, created as part of target creation.
4389
4390 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4391 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4392 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4393 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4394 to be much more board-specific.
4395 The key steps you use might look something like this
4396
4397 @example
4398 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4399 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4400 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4401 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4402 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4403 @end example
4404
4405 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4406 on-chip SRAM.
4407 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4408 writes to target memory;
4409 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4410 GDB memory checksumming;
4411 and more.
4412
4413 @quotation Warning
4414 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4415 inaccessible when application code
4416 (such as an operating system)
4417 enables or disables the MMU.
4418 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4419 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4420 easy access to other addresses needed.
4421 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4422 @end quotation
4423
4424 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4425 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4426 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4427 controllers.
4428 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4429 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4430 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4431
4432 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4433 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4434 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4435 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4436 purposes including additional configuration.
4437
4438 @itemize @bullet
4439 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4440 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4441 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4442 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4443
4444 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4445 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4446 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4447 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4448 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4449 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4450 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4451
4452 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4453 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4454 @end itemize
4455 @end deffn
4456
4457 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4458 The options accepted by this command may also be
4459 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4460 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4461 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4462
4463 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4464 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4465 and changing its endianness.
4466
4467 @itemize @bullet
4468
4469 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4470 used to access this target.
4471
4472 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4473 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4474 create and manage DAP instances.
4475
4476 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4477 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4478
4479 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4480 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4481 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4482 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4483 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4484 same event name assigns only one handler.
4485
4486 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4487 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4488
4489 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4490 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4491 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4492 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4493 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4494 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4495 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4496
4497 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4498 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4499 or virtual address is being used.
4500
4501 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4502 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4503
4504 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4505 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4506 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4507 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4508 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4509
4510 @anchor{rtostype}
4511 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4512 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4513 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4514 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4515 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4516
4517 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4518 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4519 access the target for debugging.
4520
4521 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4522 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4523 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4524 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4525
4526 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4527 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4528 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4529 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4530 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4531
4532 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4533 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4534 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4535 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4536 command @command{gdb_port}.
4537 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4538 @end itemize
4539 @end deffn
4540
4541 @section Other $target_name Commands
4542 @cindex object command
4543
4544 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4545 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4546
4547 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4548 Once a button is created a button
4549 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4550 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4551 configure it like this:
4552
4553 @example
4554 # Create
4555 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4556 # Modify
4557 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4558 # Query
4559 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4560 # Report
4561 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4562 @end example
4563
4564 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4565 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4566
4567 @example
4568 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4569 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4570 @end example
4571
4572 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4573
4574 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4575 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4576 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4577 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4578 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4579 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4580 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4581 They are not otherwise documented here.
4582 @end deffn
4583
4584 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4585 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4586 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4587 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4588 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4589 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4590 the target side uses raw memory.
4591
4592 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4593 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4594 The script orientation comes from working with data
4595 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4596 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4597 and neither store nor return those values.
4598
4599 @itemize
4600 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4601 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4602 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4603 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4604 @end itemize
4605 @end deffn
4606
4607 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4608 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4609 @command{$target_name configure}
4610 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4611 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4612 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4613 There are a few special cases:
4614
4615 @itemize @bullet
4616 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4617 event named @var{event_name}.
4618 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4619 two parameters.
4620 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4621 This is a special case because this is set using
4622 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4623 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4624 @end itemize
4625
4626 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4627 all the targets you might use something like this:
4628
4629 @example
4630 foreach name [target names] @{
4631 set y [$name cget -endian]
4632 set z [$name cget -type]
4633 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4634 $x $name $y $z]
4635 @}
4636 @end example
4637 @end deffn
4638
4639 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4640 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4641 Displays the current target state:
4642 @code{debug-running},
4643 @code{halted},
4644 @code{reset},
4645 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4646 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4647 @end deffn
4648
4649 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4650 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4651 currently associated with this target.
4652 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4653 @end deffn
4654
4655 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4656 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4657 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4658 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4659 @end deffn
4660
4661 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4662 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4663 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4664 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4665 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4666 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4667 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4668 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4669 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4670 @end deffn
4671
4672 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4673 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4674 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4675 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4676 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4677 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4678 @end deffn
4679
4680 @anchor{targetevents}
4681 @section Target Events
4682 @cindex target events
4683 @cindex events
4684 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4685 For example:
4686 @itemize @bullet
4687 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4688 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4689 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4690 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4691 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4692 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4693 to set up system clocks or
4694 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4695 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4696 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4697 @end itemize
4698
4699 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4700 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4701 @command{target create ... -event}.
4702
4703 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4704 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4705 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4706
4707 @example
4708 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4709 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4710 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4711 @}
4712 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4713 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4714 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4715 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4716 @}
4717 @end example
4718
4719 The following target events are defined:
4720
4721 @itemize @bullet
4722 @item @b{debug-halted}
4723 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4724 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4725 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4726 @item @b{early-halted}
4727 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4728 @item @b{examine-start}
4729 @* Before target examine is called.
4730 @item @b{examine-end}
4731 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4732 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4733 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4734 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4735 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4736 connect GDB to running target.
4737 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4738 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4739 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4740 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4741 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4742 is in RAM or read only memory.
4743 Default is @code{halt}
4744 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4745 @* When GDB disconnects
4746 @item @b{gdb-end}
4747 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4748 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4749 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4750 @code{reset init})
4751 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4752 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4753 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4754 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4755 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4756 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4757 @item @b{gdb-start}
4758 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4759 @item @b{halted}
4760 @* The target has halted
4761 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4762 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4763 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4764 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4765 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4766 @item @b{reset-assert}
4767 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4768 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4769 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4770 it instead of asserting SRST.
4771 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4772 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4773 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4774 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4775 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4776 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4777 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4778 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4779 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4780 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4781 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4782 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4783 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4784 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4785 released on the scan chain.
4786 @item @b{reset-end}
4787 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4788 @item @b{reset-init}
4789 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4790 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4791
4792 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4793 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4794 multiplexing, and so on.
4795 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4796 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4797 @item @b{reset-start}
4798 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4799 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4800
4801 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4802 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4803 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4804 @item @b{resume-start}
4805 @* Before any target is resumed
4806 @item @b{resume-end}
4807 @* After all targets have resumed
4808 @item @b{resumed}
4809 @* Target has resumed
4810 @item @b{trace-config}
4811 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4812 @end itemize
4813
4814 @node Flash Commands
4815 @chapter Flash Commands
4816
4817 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4818 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4819 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4820 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4821 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4822 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4823 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4824 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4825 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4826
4827 Flash Steps:
4828 @enumerate
4829 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4830 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4831 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4832 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4833 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4834 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4835 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4836 @item GDB Flashing
4837 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4838 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4839 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4840 @end enumerate
4841
4842 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4843 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4844 so that it can't boot.
4845 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4846 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4847
4848 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4849 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4850 @cindex flash configuration
4851
4852 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4853 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4854 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4855 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4856 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4857 see the driver-specific documentation.
4858
4859 @itemize @bullet
4860 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4861 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4862 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4863 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4864 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4865 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4866 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4867 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4868 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4869 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4870 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4871 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4872 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4873 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4874 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4875 commands to the flash controller.
4876 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4877 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4878 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4879 for more information.
4880 @end itemize
4881 @quotation Note
4882 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4883 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4884 @end quotation
4885 @end deffn
4886
4887 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4888 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4889 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4890 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4891 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4892 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4893 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4894 @end deffn
4895
4896 @deffn Command {flash list}
4897 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4898 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4899 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4900 @end deffn
4901
4902 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4903 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4904 depends on the flash type.
4905 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4906 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4907 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4908 but most don't bother.
4909 @end deffn
4910
4911 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4912 @cindex flash erasing
4913 @cindex flash reading
4914 @cindex flash writing
4915 @cindex flash programming
4916 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4917
4918 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4919 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4920 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4921 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4922 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4923
4924 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4925 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4926 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4927 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4928 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4929
4930 @quotation Note
4931 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4932 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4933 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4934 back to a flash bank.
4935 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4936 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4937 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4938 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4939 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4940 @end quotation
4941
4942 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4943 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4944 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4945 disabled first.
4946 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4947 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4948 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4949
4950 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4951 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4952 up to and including @var{last}.
4953 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4954 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4955 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4956 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4957 @end deffn
4958
4959 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4960 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4961 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4962 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4963 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4964 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4965 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4966 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4967 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4968 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4969 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4970 before erase starts.
4971 @end deffn
4972
4973 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4974 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4975 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4976 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4977 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4978 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4979 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4980 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4981 before issuing this command.
4982 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4983 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4984 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4985 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4986 @end deffn
4987 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4988
4989 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4990 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4991 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4992 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4993 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4994 @end deffn
4995
4996 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
4997 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4998 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
4999 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5000 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5001 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5002 @end deffn
5003
5004 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5005 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5006 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5007 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5008 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5009 @end deffn
5010
5011 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5012 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5013 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5014 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5015 to the base address for each section in the image.
5016 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5017 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5018 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5019 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5020 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5021 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5022 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5023 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5024 each image section.
5025
5026 @quotation Warning
5027 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5028 data you want to preserve.
5029 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5030 sections might be erased with no notice.
5031 @itemize
5032 @item
5033 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5034 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5035 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5036 @item
5037 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5038 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5039 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5040 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5041 @end itemize
5042 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5043 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5044 @end quotation
5045
5046 @end deffn
5047
5048 @section Other Flash commands
5049 @cindex flash protection
5050
5051 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5052 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5053 and display that status.
5054 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5055 @end deffn
5056
5057 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5058 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5059 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5060
5061 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5062 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5063 and possibly stale information.
5064 @end deffn
5065
5066 @anchor{flashprotect}
5067 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5068 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5069 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5070 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5071 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5072 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5073 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5074 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5075 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5076 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5077 @end deffn
5078
5079 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5080 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5081 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5082 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5083 @end deffn
5084
5085 @anchor{program}
5086 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5087 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5088 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5089 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5090 @end deffn
5091
5092 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5093 @section Flash Driver List
5094 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5095 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5096 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5097
5098 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5099 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5100 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5101
5102 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5103
5104 @itemize
5105 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5106 @end itemize
5107
5108 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5109 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5110 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5111 @example
5112 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5113 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5114 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5115 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5116 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5117 @end example
5118 @end deffn
5119
5120 @subsection External Flash
5121
5122 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5123 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5124 @cindex CFI
5125 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5126 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5127 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5128 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5129 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5130 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5131 configure a bus and its timings), or
5132 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5133 on the flash chip.
5134 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5135 speed up operation.
5136
5137 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5138
5139 @itemize
5140 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5141 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5142 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5143 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5144 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5145 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5146 @end itemize
5147
5148 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5149 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5150
5151 @example
5152 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5153 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5154 @end example
5155
5156 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5157 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5158 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5159
5160 @example
5161 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5162 @end example
5163
5164 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5165 @end deffn
5166
5167 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5168 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5169 @cindex SPI
5170 @cindex jtagspi
5171 @cindex bscan_spi
5172 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5173 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5174 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5175 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5176 accessed through JTAG.
5177
5178 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5179 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5180 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5181 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5182 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5183 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5184
5185 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5186 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5187 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5188 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5189 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5190 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5191 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5192 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5193
5194 @itemize
5195 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5196 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5197 @var{USER1} instruction.
5198 @end itemize
5199
5200 @example
5201 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5202 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5203 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5204 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5205 @end example
5206 @end deffn
5207
5208 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5209 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5210 @cindex xcf
5211 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5212 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5213 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5214 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5215 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5216
5217 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5218 command accepts additional parameters:
5219 @itemize
5220 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5221 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5222 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5223 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5224 in master mode.
5225 @end itemize
5226 @example
5227 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5228 @end example
5229 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5230 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5231 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5232 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5233 dedicated sector.
5234 @end deffn
5235
5236 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5237 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5238 button.
5239 @example
5240 xcf configure 0
5241 @end example
5242 @end deffn
5243
5244 Additional driver notes:
5245 @itemize
5246 @item Only single revision supported.
5247 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5248 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5249 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5250 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5251 @end itemize
5252 @end deffn
5253
5254 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5255 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5256 @cindex SPIFI
5257 @cindex lpcspifi
5258 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5259 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5260 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5261
5262 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5263 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5264 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5265 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5266 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5267
5268 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5269 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5270 are configured by the driver.
5271
5272 @example
5273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5274 @end example
5275
5276 @end deffn
5277
5278 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5279 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5280 @cindex SMI
5281 @cindex stmsmi
5282 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5283 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5284 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5285 SPI flash devices.
5286 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5287 flash devices can be connected.
5288
5289 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5290 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5291 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5292 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5293 the flash content.
5294
5295 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5296 to identify the memory bank.
5297 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5298 flash size, are detected automatically.
5299
5300 @example
5301 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5302 @end example
5303
5304 @end deffn
5305
5306 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5307 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5308 Microcontroller platform.
5309
5310 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5311 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5312
5313 @example
5314 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5315 @end example
5316
5317 @end deffn
5318
5319 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5320 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5321 @cindex ath79
5322 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5323 chip selects.
5324 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5325 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5326 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5327 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5328 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5329 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5330
5331 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5332 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5333 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5334 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5335 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5336 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5337 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5338 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5339 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5340 with the default CS0.
5341 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5342 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5343 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5344
5345 @example
5346 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5347
5348 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5349 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5350 # banks.
5351 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5352 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5353 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5354 @end example
5355
5356 @end deffn
5357
5358 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5359
5360 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5361 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5362 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5363 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5364 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5365 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5366
5367 @example
5368 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5369 @end example
5370 @end deffn
5371
5372 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5373 @cindex ambiqmicro
5374 @cindex apollo
5375 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5376 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5377 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5378 with the target using SWD.
5379
5380 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5381 the device class of the MCU.
5382 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5383 to set up the flash banks.
5384 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5385 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5386
5387 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5388 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5389 and the second bank starts after the first.
5390
5391 @example
5392 # Flash bank 0
5393 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5394 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5395 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5396 $_TARGETNAME
5397 @end example
5398
5399 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5400 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5401 are available to the user.
5402
5403 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5404
5405 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5406 Erase entire bank.
5407 @end deffn
5408 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5409 Erase device pages.
5410 @end deffn
5411 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5412 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5413 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5414 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5415 the flash.
5416 @end deffn
5417 @end deffn
5418
5419 @anchor{at91samd}
5420 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5421 @cindex at91samd
5422 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5423 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5424 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5425
5426 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5427 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5428 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5429 processor to be halted.
5430 @end deffn
5431
5432 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5433 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5434 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5435 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5436 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5437 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5438
5439 @example
5440 at91samd set-security enable
5441 @end example
5442 @end deffn
5443
5444 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5445 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5446 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5447 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5448 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5449 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5450 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5451 in order to disable this feature.
5452
5453 @example
5454 at91samd eeprom
5455 at91samd eeprom 1024
5456 @end example
5457 @end deffn
5458
5459 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5460 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5461 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5462 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5463 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5464 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5465
5466 @example
5467 at91samd bootloader
5468 at91samd bootloader 16384
5469 @end example
5470 @end deffn
5471
5472 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5473 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5474 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5475 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5476 @end deffn
5477
5478 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5479 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5480 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5481 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5482 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5483 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5484 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5485 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5486
5487 @example
5488 # Read user row
5489 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5490 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5491 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5492 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5493 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5494 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5495 @end example
5496 @end deffn
5497
5498 @end deffn
5499
5500 @anchor{at91sam3}
5501 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5502 @cindex at91sam3
5503 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5504 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5505 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5506 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5507 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5508 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5509 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5510 chips are confirmed.}
5511
5512 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5513 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5514 the following fixed locations:
5515
5516 @example
5517 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5518 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5519 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5520 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5521 @end example
5522
5523 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5524 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5525 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5526
5527 @itemize
5528 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5529 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5530 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5531 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5532 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5533 @end itemize
5534
5535 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5536
5537 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5538 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5539 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5540 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5541 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5542 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5543 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5544
5545 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5546 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5547 @end deffn
5548
5549 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5550 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5551 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5552 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5553 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5554 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5555 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5556 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5557 @end deffn
5558
5559 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5560 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5561 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5562 @end deffn
5563 @end deffn
5564
5565 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5566 @cindex at91sam4
5567 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5568 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5569 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5570 @end deffn
5571
5572 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5573 @cindex at91sam4l
5574 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5575 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5576 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5577
5578 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5579 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5580 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5581 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5582 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5583 @end deffn
5584 @end deffn
5585
5586 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5587 @cindex atsamv
5588 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5589 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5590 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5591 @end deffn
5592
5593 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5594 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5595 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5596 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5597 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5598
5599 @example
5600 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5601 @end example
5602
5603 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5604 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5605
5606 @itemize
5607 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5608 @item @var{banks}
5609 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5610 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5611 @item @var{pages_size}
5612 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5613 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5614 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5615 @end itemize
5616
5617 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5618 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5619 will be autoconfigured.
5620 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5621
5622 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5623 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5624 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5625 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5626 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5627
5628 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5629 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5630 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5631 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5632 are not truly general purpose).
5633 @quotation Note
5634 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5635 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5636 @end quotation
5637 @end deffn
5638 @end deffn
5639
5640 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5641 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5642 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5643 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5644 @end deffn
5645
5646 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5647 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5648 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5649 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5650
5651 @example
5652 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5653 @end example
5654
5655 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5656 each single sector one by one.
5657
5658 @example
5659 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5660 @end example
5661
5662 @example
5663 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5664 @end example
5665
5666 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5667 @end deffn
5668
5669 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5670 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5671 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5672 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5673 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. Flash bank 0
5674 starts at address 0.
5675
5676 @example
5677 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5678 @end example
5679 @end deffn
5680
5681 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5682 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5683 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5684 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5685 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5686 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5687 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5688 and programming the serial flash.
5689
5690 @example
5691 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5692 @end example
5693 @end deffn
5694
5695 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5696 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5697 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5698 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5699 autoconfigures itself.
5700 @example
5701 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5702 @end example
5703 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5704 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5705 this via the following command:
5706 @example
5707 efm32 debuglock num
5708 @end example
5709 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5710 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5711 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5712 supported.}
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5716 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5717 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5718 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5719 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5720 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5721
5722 @example
5723 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5724 @end example
5725
5726 @deffn Command {esirisc_flash mass_erase} (bank_id)
5727 Erases all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5728 @end deffn
5729
5730 @deffn Command {esirisc_flash ref_erase} (bank_id)
5731 Erases the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. This is
5732 an uncommon operation.
5733 @end deffn
5734 @end deffn
5735
5736 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5737 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5738 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5739 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5740 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5741 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5742 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5743
5744 @example
5745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5746 @end example
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5750 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5751 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5752 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5753 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5754 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5755 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5756 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5757 characters) ignored.
5758
5759 @example
5760 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5761 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5762 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5763 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5764 @end example
5765 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5766 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5767 @end deffn
5768
5769 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5770 @cindex kinetis
5771 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5772 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5773 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5774 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5775 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5776 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5777
5778 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5779 @itemize
5780 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5781 @end itemize
5782
5783 @example
5784 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5785 @end example
5786
5787 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5788 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5789 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5790 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5794 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5795 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5796 set by 'flash protect' command.
5797 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5798 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5799 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5800 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5801 with the rest of a flash image.
5802 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5803 @end deffn
5804
5805 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5806 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5807 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5808 @end deffn
5809
5810 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5811 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5812 @end deffn
5813
5814 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5815 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5816 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5817 @end deffn
5818
5819 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5820 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5821 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5822 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5823 command completes.
5824 @end deffn
5825
5826 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5827 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5828 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5829 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5830 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5831
5832 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5833 Program Partition command.
5834
5835 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5836 Reset the device after partition setting.
5837
5838 Show partition size:
5839 @example
5840 kinetis nvm_partition info
5841 @end example
5842
5843 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5844 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5845 @example
5846 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5847 @end example
5848
5849 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5850 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5851 @example
5852 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5853 @end example
5854 @end deffn
5855
5856 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5857 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5858 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5859 @end deffn
5860
5861 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5862 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5863 Command disables watchdog timer.
5864 @end deffn
5865 @end deffn
5866
5867 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5868 @cindex kinetis_ke
5869 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5870 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5871 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5872 autoconfigures itself.
5873 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5874
5875 @example
5876 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5877 @end example
5878
5879 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5880 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5881 @end deffn
5882
5883 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5884 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5885 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5886 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5887 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5888 @end deffn
5889
5890 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5891 Command disables watchdog timer.
5892 @end deffn
5893 @end deffn
5894
5895 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5896 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5897 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5898 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5899 microcontroller families from NXP.
5900
5901 @quotation Note
5902 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5903 driver:
5904 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5905 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5906 @end quotation
5907
5908 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5909 which must appear in the following order:
5910
5911 @itemize
5912 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5913 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5914 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5915 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5916 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5917 LPC43x[2357])
5918 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5919 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5920 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5921 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5922 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5923 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5924 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5925 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5926 at which the core is running
5927 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5928 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5929 @quotation Note
5930 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5931 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5932 However, if you do provide it,
5933 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5934 @end quotation
5935 @end itemize
5936
5937 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5938
5939 @example
5940 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5941 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5942 @end example
5943
5944 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5945 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5946 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5947 @end deffn
5948 @end deffn
5949
5950 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5951 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5952 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5953 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5954 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5955 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5956
5957 @example
5958 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5959 @end example
5960 @end deffn
5961
5962 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5963 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5964 from NXP.
5965
5966 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5967 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5968 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5969 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5970 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5971 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5972 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5973 you start the PLL.
5974
5975 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5976
5977 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5978 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5979 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5980
5981 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5982 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5983 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5984 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5985 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5986 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5987 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5988
5989 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5990 @example
5991 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5992 @end example
5993
5994 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5995 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5996 @code{flash banks} command.
5997
5998 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5999 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6000 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6001 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6002 a known signature.
6003 Example:
6004 @example
6005 lpc2900 signature 0
6006 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6007 @end example
6008 @end deffn
6009
6010 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6011 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6012 saves it to a file in binary format.
6013 Example:
6014 @example
6015 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6016 @end example
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6020 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6021 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6022 command:
6023
6024 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6025 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6026 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6027 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6028
6029 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6030 Example:
6031 @example
6032 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6033 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6034 @end example
6035 @end deffn
6036
6037 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6038 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6039 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6040 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6041 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6042 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6043 912 bytes.
6044 @quotation Attention
6045 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6046 @end quotation
6047 Example:
6048 @example
6049 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6050 @end example
6051 @end deffn
6052
6053 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6054 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6055 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6056 after the next power cycle.
6057 @quotation Attention
6058 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6059 @end quotation
6060 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6061 Example:
6062 @example
6063 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6064 flash info 0
6065 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6066 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6067 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6068 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6069 @end example
6070 @end deffn
6071
6072 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6073 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6074 effective after the next power cycle.
6075 @quotation Attention
6076 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6077 @end quotation
6078 Examples:
6079 @example
6080 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6081 @end example
6082 @end deffn
6083 @end deffn
6084
6085 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6086 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6087 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6088 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6089
6090 @example
6091 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6092 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6093 @end example
6094
6095 @itemize @bullet
6096 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6097 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6098 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6099 @end itemize
6100
6101 Example usage:
6102 @example
6103 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6104 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6105 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6106 @} else @{
6107 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6108 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6109 @}
6110 @end example
6111 @end deffn
6112
6113 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6114 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6115 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6116 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6117 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6118 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6119
6120 @example
6121 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6122 @end example
6123
6124 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6125 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6126 only the main program flash.
6127
6128 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6129 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6130 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6131 @end deffn
6132
6133 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6134 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6135 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6136 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6137
6138 To erase and program the BSL:
6139 @example
6140 msp432 bsl unlock
6141 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6142 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6143 msp432 bsl lock
6144 @end example
6145 @end deffn
6146 @end deffn
6147
6148 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6149 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6150 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6151 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6152 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6153 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6154 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6155 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6156 also have division into regions: main and info.
6157 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6158 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6159
6160 @example
6161 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6162 @end example
6163
6164 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6165
6166 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6167 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6168 @end deffn
6169
6170 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6171 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6172 @end deffn
6173
6174 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6175 Erase all userflash including info region.
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6179 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6180 @end deffn
6181
6182 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6183 Check sectors protect.
6184 @end deffn
6185
6186 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6187 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6188 @end deffn
6189
6190 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6191 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6192 @end deffn
6193
6194 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6195 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6196 @end deffn
6197
6198 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6199 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6203 Show information about flash driver.
6204 @end deffn
6205
6206 @end deffn
6207
6208 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6209 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6210 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6211 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6212 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6213
6214 @example
6215 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6216 @end example
6217
6218 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6219
6220 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6221 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6222 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6223 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6224 code.
6225 @end deffn
6226
6227 @end deffn
6228
6229 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6230 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6231 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6232
6233 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6234 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6235 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6236 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6237
6238 @example
6239 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6240 @end example
6241 @end deffn
6242
6243 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6244 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6245 and integrate flash memory.
6246
6247 @example
6248 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6249 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6250 @end example
6251
6252 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6253 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6254 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6255 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6256 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6257 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6258 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6259 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6260 @end deffn
6261 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6262 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6263 This will remove any Code Protection.
6264 @end deffn
6265 @end deffn
6266
6267 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6268 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6269 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6270 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6271 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6272
6273 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6274 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6275
6276 @example
6277 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6278 @end example
6279
6280 psoc4-specific commands
6281 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6282 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6283
6284 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6285 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6286
6287 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6288 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6289 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6290
6291 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6292 @end deffn
6293
6294 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6295 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6296
6297 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6298 @end deffn
6299 @end deffn
6300
6301 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6302 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6303 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6304 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6305 apart from the base address.
6306
6307 @example
6308 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6309 @end example
6310
6311 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6312 @quotation Attention
6313 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6314 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6315 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6316 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6317 @end quotation
6318
6319 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6320
6321 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6322 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6323 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6324 @end deffn
6325 @end deffn
6326
6327 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6328 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6329 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6330 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6331 apart from the base address.
6332
6333 @example
6334 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6335 @end example
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6339 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6340 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6341 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6342
6343 @example
6344 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6345 @end example
6346
6347 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6348
6349 @itemize
6350 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6351 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6352 @end itemize
6353
6354 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6355
6356 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6357 @quotation Attention
6358 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6359 after successful write.
6360 @end quotation
6361 @end deffn
6362
6363 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6364 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6365 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6366 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6367
6368 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6369 @itemize @bullet
6370 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6371 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6372 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6373 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6374 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6375 row size: 512 bytes.
6376 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6377 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6378 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6379 operation will erase row automatically.
6380 @end itemize
6381
6382 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6383 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6384
6385 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6386
6387 @example
6388 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6389 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6390 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6391 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6392 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6393 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6394
6395 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6396 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6397 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6398 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6399 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6400 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6401 @end example
6402
6403 psoc6-specific commands
6404 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6405 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6406 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6407 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6408 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6409 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6410 @end deffn
6411
6412 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6413 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6414 by @command{flash banks}.
6415 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6416 @end deffn
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6420 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6421 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6422 and SWD interface.
6423 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6424 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6425
6426 @example
6427 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6428 @end example
6429
6430 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6431
6432 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6433 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6434 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6435 @end deffn
6436
6437 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6438 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6439 @end deffn
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6443 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6444 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6445 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6446 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6447
6448 @example
6449 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6450 @end example
6451
6452 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6453 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6454 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6455 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6456 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6457 disabled.
6458
6459 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6460 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6461 @quotation Warning
6462 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6463 applied to all of them.
6464 @end quotation
6465 @end deffn
6466 @end deffn
6467
6468 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6469 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6470 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6471 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6472 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6473
6474 @example
6475 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6476 @end example
6477
6478 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6479 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6480 the flash driver.
6481
6482 @example
6483 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6484 @end example
6485
6486 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6487 as per the following example.
6488 @example
6489 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6490 @end example
6491
6492 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6493
6494 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6495 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6496 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6497 @end deffn
6498
6499 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6500 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6501 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6502 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6503 @end deffn
6504
6505 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6506 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6507 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6508 @end deffn
6509
6510 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6511 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6512 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6513 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6514 @end deffn
6515
6516 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6517 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6518 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6519 @end deffn
6520
6521 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6522 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6523 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6524 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6525 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6526 @end deffn
6527 @end deffn
6528
6529 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6530 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6531 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6532 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6533 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6534
6535 @example
6536 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6537 @end example
6538
6539 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6540 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6541 the flash driver.
6542
6543 @example
6544 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6545 @end example
6546
6547 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6548
6549 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6550 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6551 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6552 @end deffn
6553
6554 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6555 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6556 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6557 @end deffn
6558
6559 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6560 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6561 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6562 @end deffn
6563
6564 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6565 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6566 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6567 @end deffn
6568
6569 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6570 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6571 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6572 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6573 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6574 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6575 @end deffn
6576
6577 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6578 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6579 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6580 @end deffn
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6584 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6585 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6586 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6587 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6588
6589 @example
6590 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6591 @end example
6592
6593 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6594 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6595 the flash driver.
6596
6597 @example
6598 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6599 @end example
6600
6601 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6602
6603 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6604 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6605 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6606 @end deffn
6607
6608 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6609 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6610 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6614 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6615 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6616 @end deffn
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6620 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6621 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6622 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6623 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6624
6625 @example
6626 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6627 @end example
6628
6629 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6630 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6631 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6632 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6633 second bank.
6634
6635 @example
6636 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6637 @end example
6638
6639 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6640
6641 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6642 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6643 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6644 @end deffn
6645
6646 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6647 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6648 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6649 @end deffn
6650
6651 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6652 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6653 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6654 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6655 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6656 @end deffn
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6660 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6661 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6662 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6663 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6664
6665 @example
6666 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6667 @end example
6668
6669 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6670 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6671 the flash driver.
6672
6673 @example
6674 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6675 @end example
6676
6677 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6678
6679 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6680 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6681 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6682 @end deffn
6683
6684 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6685 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6686 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6690 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6691 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6692 @end deffn
6693
6694 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6695 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6696 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6697 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6698
6699 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6700 @example
6701 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6702 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6703 @end example
6704
6705 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6706 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6707 @end deffn
6708
6709 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6710 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6711 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6712 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6713 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6714
6715 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6716 @example
6717 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6718 @end example
6719
6720 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6721 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6722 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6726 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6727 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6728 @end deffn
6729 @end deffn
6730
6731 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6732 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6733 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6734 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6735 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6736
6737 @example
6738 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6739 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6740 @end example
6741
6742 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6743 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6744 for the specified flash bank.
6745 @end deffn
6746 @end deffn
6747
6748 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6749 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6750 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6751 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6752 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6753
6754 @example
6755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6756 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6757 @end example
6758
6759 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6760 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6761 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6762
6763 @itemize @bullet
6764 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6765 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6766 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6767 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6768 @end itemize
6769 @end deffn
6770
6771 @end deffn
6772
6773 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6774 @cindex str9xpec
6775
6776 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6777 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6778 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6779 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6780
6781 Here is some background info to help
6782 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6783 the str9:
6784 @enumerate
6785 @item
6786 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6787 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6788 @item
6789 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6790 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6791 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6792 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6793 @end enumerate
6794
6795 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6796 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6797 configured for flash bank 0.
6798 @example
6799 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6800 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6801 jtag_reset 0 1
6802 # turn off target polling
6803 poll off
6804 # disable str9 core
6805 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6806 # read option bytes
6807 str9xpec options_read 0
6808 # re-enable str9 core
6809 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6810 poll on
6811 reset halt
6812 @end example
6813 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6814 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6815 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6816 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6817
6818 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6819
6820 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6821 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6822 @end deffn
6823
6824 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6825 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6826 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6830 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6831 erase the device.
6832 @end deffn
6833
6834 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6835 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6839 Configure str9 boot bank.
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6843 Configure str9 lvd source.
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6847 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6851 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6852 @end deffn
6853
6854 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6855 Read str9 option bytes.
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6859 Write str9 option bytes.
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6863 unlock str9 device.
6864 @end deffn
6865
6866 @end deffn
6867
6868 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6869 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6870 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6871 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6872
6873 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6874
6875 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6876 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6877 @end deffn
6878
6879 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6880 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6881 @end deffn
6882
6883 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6884 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6885 the flash clock.
6886 @end deffn
6887 @end deffn
6888
6889 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6890 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6891 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6895 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6896 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6897
6898 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6899
6900 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6901 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6902 @end deffn
6903
6904 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6905 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6906 @end deffn
6907
6908 @end deffn
6909
6910 @section NAND Flash Commands
6911 @cindex NAND
6912
6913 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6914 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6915 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6916
6917 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6918 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6919 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6920 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6921 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6922 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6923
6924 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6925 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6926 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6927 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6928 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6929 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6930 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6931 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6932 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6933 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6934
6935 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6936 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6937 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6938 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6939 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6940 every 512 bytes of data.
6941
6942 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6943 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6944 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6945 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6946 ECC mode is used.
6947
6948 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6949 @enumerate
6950 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6951 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6952 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6953 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6954 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6955 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6956 to access that device.
6957 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6958 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6959 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6960 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6961 de-brick a board.
6962 @end enumerate
6963
6964 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6965 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6966 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6967 are only 32 bits wide.
6968 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6969 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6970 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6971 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6972
6973 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6974 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6975 @cindex NAND configuration
6976
6977 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6978 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6979 OpenOCD has initialized.
6980
6981 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6982 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6983 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6984 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6985 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6986 they were a single (larger) device.
6987 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6988 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6989
6990 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6991 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6992 configuration files, not interactively.
6993
6994 @itemize @bullet
6995 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6996 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6997 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6998 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6999 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7000 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7001 commands to the NAND controller.
7002 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7003 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7004 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7005 for more information.
7006 @end itemize
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @deffn Command {nand list}
7010 Prints a summary of each device declared
7011 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7012 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7013 @example
7014 > nand list
7015 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7016 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7017 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7018 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7019 >
7020 @end example
7021 @end deffn
7022
7023 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7024 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7025 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7026 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7027 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7028 it with most other NAND commands.
7029 @end deffn
7030
7031 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7032
7033 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7034 @cindex NAND reading
7035 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7036 starting at the specified offset.
7037 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7038
7039 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7040 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7041
7042 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7043 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7044 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7045
7046 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7047 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7048 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7049 method which handled that error correction.
7050
7051 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7052 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7053 @itemize @bullet
7054 @item no oob_* parameter
7055 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7056 @item @code{oob_raw}
7057 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7058 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7059 spare areas associated with each data page.
7060 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7061 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7062 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7063 @item @code{oob_only}
7064 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7065 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7066 spare areas associated with each data page.
7067 @end itemize
7068 @end deffn
7069
7070 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7071 @cindex NAND erasing
7072 @cindex NAND programming
7073 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7074 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7075 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7076 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7077 If those parameters are not specified,
7078 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7079 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7080
7081 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7082 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7083 block marker.
7084 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7085 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7089 @cindex NAND writing
7090 @cindex NAND programming
7091 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7092 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7093 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7094 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7095
7096 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7097 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7098
7099 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7100 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7101 past the end of the device.
7102 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7103 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7104 if that's being written.)
7105
7106 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7107 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7108 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7109
7110 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7111 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7112 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7113 @itemize @bullet
7114 @item no oob_* parameter
7115 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7116 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7117 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7118 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7119 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7120 @item @code{oob_only}
7121 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7122 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7123 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7124 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7125 @item @code{oob_raw}
7126 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7127 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7128 un-altered OOB.
7129 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7130 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7131 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7132 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7133 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7134 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7135 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7136 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7137 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7138 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7139 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7140 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7141 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7142 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7143 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7144 @end itemize
7145 @end deffn
7146
7147 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7148 @cindex NAND verification
7149 @cindex NAND programming
7150 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7151 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7152 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7153
7154 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7155 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7156
7157 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7158 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7159 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7160 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7161 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7162
7163 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7164 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7165 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7166
7167 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7168 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7169 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7170 be removed in a future release.
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @subsection Other NAND commands
7174 @cindex NAND other commands
7175
7176 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7177 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7178 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7179 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7180 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7181 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7182 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7183 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7184
7185 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7186 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7187 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7188 @end deffn
7189
7190 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7191 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7192 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7193 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7194 status for each block.
7195 @end deffn
7196
7197 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7198 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7199 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7200
7201 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7202 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7203 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7204 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7205 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7206
7207 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7208 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7209 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7210 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7211 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7212 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7213 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7214 @end deffn
7215
7216 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7217 @subsection NAND Driver List
7218 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7219 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7220 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7221
7222 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7223 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7224 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7225 address of the ECC controller.
7226 @example
7227 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7228 @end example
7229 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7230 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7231 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7232 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7233 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7234 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7235 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7236 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7237 @end deffn
7238 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7239 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7240 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7241 @end deffn
7242
7243 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7244 properly configured for input or output.
7245 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7246 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7247 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7248 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7249 @end deffn
7250 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7251 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7252 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7253 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7254 @end deffn
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7258 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7259 chips from Texas Instruments.
7260 It takes three extra parameters:
7261 address of the NAND chip;
7262 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7263 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7264 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7265 @example
7266 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7267 @end example
7268 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7269 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7270 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7271 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7272 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7273 @end deffn
7274
7275 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7276 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7277 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7278 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7279 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7280 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7281 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7282 @end deffn
7283
7284 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7285 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7286 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7287 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7288 @end deffn
7289 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7290
7291 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7292 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7293 should work for this chip as well.
7294 @end deffn
7295
7296 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7297 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7298 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7299 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7300 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7301 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7302 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7303 @example
7304 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7305 @end example
7306 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7307 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7308 without parameter query status.
7309 @end deffn
7310 @end deffn
7311
7312 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7313 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7314 parameter: the address of the controller.
7315 @example
7316 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7317 @end example
7318 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7319 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7320 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7321 change any behavior.
7322 @end deffn
7323
7324 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7325 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7326 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7327 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7328 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7329 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7330 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7331 specialized commands.
7332 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7333 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7334 change any behavior.
7335 @end deffn
7336
7337 @section mFlash
7338
7339 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7340 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7341
7342 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7343 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7344 address @var{base}.
7345 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7346 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7347
7348 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7349
7350 @example
7351 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7352 @end example
7353
7354 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7355
7356 @example
7357 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7358 @end example
7359 @end deffn
7360
7361 @subsection mFlash commands
7362 @cindex mFlash commands
7363
7364 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7365 Configure mflash PLL.
7366 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7367 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7368 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7369 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7370 @end deffn
7371
7372 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7373 Configure bootable option.
7374 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7375 (4kB) for boot.
7376 @end deffn
7377
7378 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7379 Configure storage information.
7380 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7381 written.
7382 @end deffn
7383
7384 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7385 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7386 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7390 Probe mflash.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7394 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7395 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @node Flash Programming
7399 @chapter Flash Programming
7400
7401 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7402 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7403 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7404
7405 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7406 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7407
7408 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7409 @enumerate
7410 @item 'init' is executed.
7411 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7412 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7413 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7414 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7415 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7416 @end enumerate
7417
7418 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7419
7420 @example
7421 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7422 # are optional parameters
7423 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7424 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7425
7426 # binary files need the flash address passing
7427 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7428 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7429 @end example
7430
7431 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7432 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7433 @cindex PLD
7434 @cindex FPGA
7435
7436 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7437 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7438 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7439 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7440 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7441 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7442 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7443
7444 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7445
7446 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7447 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7448 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7449
7450 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7451 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7452
7453 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7454 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7455 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7456 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7457 behavior.
7458 @end deffn
7459
7460 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7461 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7462 @end deffn
7463
7464 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7465 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7466 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7470
7471 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7472 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7473 that particular type of PLD.
7474
7475 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7476 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7477 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7478
7479 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7480 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7481 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7482
7483 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7484 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7485 for FPGA @var{num}.
7486 @end deffn
7487 @end deffn
7488
7489 @node General Commands
7490 @chapter General Commands
7491 @cindex commands
7492
7493 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7494 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7495 commands are documented elsewhere.
7496
7497 Intent:
7498 @itemize @bullet
7499 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7500 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7501 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7502 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7503
7504 @item @b{From the human}
7505 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7506 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7507
7508 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7509 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7510 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7511
7512 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7513 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7514 port is 5555.
7515 @end itemize
7516
7517
7518 @section Server Commands
7519
7520 @deffn {Command} exit
7521 Exits the current telnet session.
7522 @end deffn
7523
7524 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7525 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7526 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7527 Not every command provides helptext.
7528
7529 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7530 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7531 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7532 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7533 @end deffn
7534
7535 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7536 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7537 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7538 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7539 Useful in connection with script files
7540 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7541 @end deffn
7542
7543 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7544 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7545 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7546 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7547
7548 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7549 @example
7550 # redefine shutdown
7551 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7552 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7553 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7554 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7555 original_shutdown
7556 @}
7557 @end example
7558 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7559 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @anchor{debuglevel}
7563 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7564 @cindex message level
7565 Display debug level.
7566 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7567 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7568 Level 0 is error messages only;
7569 level 1 adds warnings;
7570 level 2 adds informational messages;
7571 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7572 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7573 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7574 the command line along with the location of that log
7575 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7576 @xref{Running}.
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7580 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7581 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7582 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7583 @example
7584 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7585 @end example
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7589 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7590 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7594 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7595 @end deffn
7596
7597 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7598 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7599 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7600 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7601 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7605 @section Target State handling
7606 @cindex reset
7607 @cindex halt
7608 @cindex target initialization
7609
7610 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7611 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7612 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7613 a current target which is used to perform the
7614 various operations. The current target may be changed
7615 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7616 target which should become current.
7617
7618 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7619 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7620 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7621 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7622 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7623
7624 @emph{With no arguments}:
7625 list all available registers for the current target,
7626 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7627 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7628 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7629 are flagged as such.
7630
7631 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7632 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7633 bypassing any internal cache.
7634
7635 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7636 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7637 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7638 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7639 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7640 relevant module will flush such values.
7641
7642 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7643 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7644
7645 @example
7646 > reg
7647 ===== ARM registers
7648 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7649 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7650 (2) r2 (/32)
7651 ...
7652 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7653 >
7654 @end example
7655 @end deffn
7656
7657 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7658 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7659 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7660 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7661 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7662 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7663 (and enter debug mode).
7664 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7665
7666 @quotation Warning
7667 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7668 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7669 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7670 power mode by gating the core clock;
7671 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7672
7673 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7674 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7675 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7676 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7677 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7678 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7679
7680 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7681 work with a JTAG debugger.
7682 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7683 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7684 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7685 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7686 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7687 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7688 @end quotation
7689
7690 @end deffn
7691
7692 @deffn Command resume [address]
7693 Resume the target at its current code position,
7694 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7695 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7696 @end deffn
7697
7698 @deffn Command step [address]
7699 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7700 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7701 @end deffn
7702
7703 @anchor{resetcommand}
7704 @deffn Command reset
7705 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7706 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7707 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7708 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7709 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7710 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7711
7712 The optional parameter specifies what should
7713 happen after the reset.
7714 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7715 The other options will not work on all systems.
7716 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7717
7718 @itemize @minus
7719 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7720 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7721 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7722 @end itemize
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7726 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7727 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7728 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7729 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7730 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7731 state.
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @section I/O Utilities
7735
7736 These commands are available when
7737 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7738 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7739 notably the ZY1000.
7740 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7741
7742 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7743
7744 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7745 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7746 the text file @file{filename}.
7747 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7748 The last string is followed by a newline.
7749 @end deffn
7750
7751 @deffn Command cat filename
7752 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7753 @end deffn
7754
7755 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7756 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7757 into @file{dest_filename}.
7758 @end deffn
7759
7760 @deffn Command ip
7761 @emph{No description provided.}
7762 @end deffn
7763
7764 @deffn Command ls
7765 @emph{No description provided.}
7766 @end deffn
7767
7768 @deffn Command mac
7769 @emph{No description provided.}
7770 @end deffn
7771
7772 @deffn Command meminfo
7773 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7774 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7775 @end deffn
7776
7777 @deffn Command peek
7778 @emph{No description provided.}
7779 @end deffn
7780
7781 @deffn Command poke
7782 @emph{No description provided.}
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @deffn Command rm filename
7786 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7787 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7788 @end deffn
7789
7790 @deffn Command trunc filename
7791 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7792 @end deffn
7793
7794 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7795 @section Memory access commands
7796 @cindex memory access
7797
7798 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7799 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7800 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7801 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7802
7803 @enumerate
7804 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7805 to change the current target.
7806 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7807 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7808 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7809 @end enumerate
7810
7811 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7812 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7813 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7814 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7815 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7816 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7817 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7818 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7819 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7820 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7821 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7822 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7823 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7827 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7828 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7829 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7830 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7831 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7832 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7833 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7834 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7835 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7836 @end deffn
7837
7838 @anchor{imageaccess}
7839 @section Image loading commands
7840 @cindex image loading
7841 @cindex image dumping
7842
7843 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7844 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7845 binary file named @var{filename}.
7846 @end deffn
7847
7848 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7849 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7850 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7854 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7855 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7856 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7857 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7858 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7859 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7860 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7861 separately.
7862 @end deffn
7863
7864 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7865 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7866 The file format may optionally be specified
7867 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7868 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
7869 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7870 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7871 @example
7872 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7873 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7874 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7875 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7876 $address $length
7877 @}
7878 @end example
7879 @end deffn
7880
7881 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7882 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7883 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7884 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7885 The file format may optionally be specified
7886 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7890 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7891 The file format may optionally be specified
7892 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7893 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7897 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7898 The file format may optionally be specified
7899 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7900 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903
7904 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7905 @cindex breakpoint
7906 @cindex watchpoint
7907
7908 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7909 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7910 watchpoints.
7911 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7912
7913 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7914 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7915 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7916 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7917 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7918 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7919
7920 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7921 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7925 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7926 @end deffn
7927
7928 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7929 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7930 @end deffn
7931
7932 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7933 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7934 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7935 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7936 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7937 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7938 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7939 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7940 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7941 @end deffn
7942
7943 @section Misc Commands
7944
7945 @cindex profiling
7946 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7947 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7948 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7949 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7950 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7951 limit the address range.
7952 @end deffn
7953
7954 @deffn Command {version}
7955 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7956 @end deffn
7957
7958 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7959 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7960 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7961 @end deffn
7962
7963 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7964 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7965 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7966 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7967
7968 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7969 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7970 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7971 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7972
7973 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7974 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7975 @cindex tracing
7976 @cindex ETM
7977 @cindex ETB
7978
7979 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7980 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7981 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7982
7983 @itemize
7984 @item
7985 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7986 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7987 supports such an interface.
7988 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7989 and trace port support.)
7990 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7991 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7992 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7993 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7994 in the board-specific configuration file.
7995 @item
7996 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7997 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7998 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7999 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8000 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8001 @end itemize
8002
8003 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8004
8005 @quotation Issues
8006 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8007 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8008
8009 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8010 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8011 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8012 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8013 dummy trace port driver}.
8014
8015 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8016 as well as tracing only during specific states
8017 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8018
8019 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8020 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8021 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8022 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8023 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8024
8025 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8026 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8027 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8028 this original style of JTAG access.
8029 @end quotation
8030
8031 @subsection ETM Configuration
8032 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8033
8034 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8035 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8036 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8037
8038 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8039 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8040 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8041 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8042 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8043 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8044 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8045 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8046 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8047
8048 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8049 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8050 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8051
8052 @quotation Warning
8053 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8054 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8055 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8056 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8057 @end quotation
8058
8059 @quotation Note
8060 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8061 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8062 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8063 what CPU activities are traced.
8064 @end quotation
8065 @end deffn
8066
8067 @deffn Command {etm info}
8068 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8069 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8070 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8071 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn Command {etm status}
8075 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8076 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8077 Did trace data overflow?
8078 Was it triggered?
8079 @end deffn
8080
8081 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8082 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8083 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8084 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8085 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8086
8087 @itemize
8088 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8089 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8090 The value is one of
8091 @option{none} (save nothing),
8092 @option{data} (save data),
8093 @option{address} (save addresses),
8094 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8095 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8096 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8097 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8098 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8099 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8100 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8101 trace stream without an image of the code.
8102 @end itemize
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8106 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8107 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8108 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8109 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8110
8111 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8112 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8113 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8114 @end deffn
8115
8116 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8117
8118 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8119 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8120 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8121
8122 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8123 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8124 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8125 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8126 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8127 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8128 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8129
8130 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8131
8132 @itemize
8133 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8134 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8135 for instruction access within that function's body.
8136 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8137 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8138 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8139 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8140 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8141 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8142 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8143 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8144 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8145 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8146 @item @emph{... more}
8147 @end itemize
8148
8149 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8150 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8151
8152 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8153 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8154 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8155 @end deffn
8156
8157 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8158 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8159 @end deffn
8160
8161 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8162 Opens an image file.
8163 @end deffn
8164
8165 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8166 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8167 @end deffn
8168
8169 @deffn Command {etm start}
8170 Starts trace data collection.
8171 @end deffn
8172
8173 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8174 Stops trace data collection.
8175 @end deffn
8176
8177 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8178 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8179
8180 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8181
8182 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8183 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8184 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8185 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8186 any trace data collection.}
8187 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8188 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8189 @end deffn
8190 @end deffn
8191
8192 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8193 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8194 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8195 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8196 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8197 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8198 @end deffn
8199 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8200 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8201 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8202 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8203 trace trigger becomes active.
8204
8205 @itemize
8206 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8207 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8208 afterwards.
8209 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8210 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8211 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8212 what caused that event to happen.
8213 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8214 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8215 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8216 how the event caused trouble.
8217 @end itemize
8218 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8219 @end deffn
8220
8221 @end deffn
8222
8223 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8224 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8225 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8226 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8227 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8228
8229 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8230 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8231
8232 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8233 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8234 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8235 @end deffn
8236
8237 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8238 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8239 @end deffn
8240
8241 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8242 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8243 @end deffn
8244 @end deffn
8245
8246 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8247 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8248 @cindex CTI
8249
8250 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8251 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8252 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8253 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8254 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8255 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8256
8257 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8258 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8259 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8260 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8261 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8262 including additional configuration.
8263 @end deffn
8264
8265 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8266 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8270 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8274 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8275 @end deffn
8276
8277 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8278 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8279 @end deffn
8280
8281 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8282 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8283 of the CTI.
8284 @end deffn
8285
8286 @deffn Command {cti names}
8287 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8288 useful in TCL scripting.
8289 @end deffn
8290
8291 @section Generic ARM
8292 @cindex ARM
8293
8294 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8295 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8296 commands that may be available.
8297
8298 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8299 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8300 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8301 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8302 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8303 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8304 @end deffn
8305
8306 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8307 @cindex disassemble
8308 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8309 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8310 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8311 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8312 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8313 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8314 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8315
8316 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8317 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8318 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8319 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8320 with a handful of exceptions.
8321 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8322 @end deffn
8323
8324 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8325 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8326 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8327 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8328 and using the MCR instruction.
8329 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8330 an ARM register.)
8331 @end deffn
8332
8333 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8334 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8335 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8336 and the MRC instruction.
8337 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8338 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8339 an ARM register.)
8340 @end deffn
8341
8342 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8343 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8344 core mode if necessary.
8345 @end deffn
8346
8347 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8348 @cindex ARM semihosting
8349 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8350
8351 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8352 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8353 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8354 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8355 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8356 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8357 @end deffn
8358
8359 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8360 @cindex ARM semihosting
8361 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8362
8363 @example
8364 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8365 @end example
8366
8367 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8368 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8369 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8370 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8371 @end deffn
8372
8373 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8374 @cindex ARM semihosting
8375 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8376 status.
8377
8378 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8379 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8380 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8381 debugger.
8382 @end deffn
8383
8384 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8385 @cindex ARM semihosting
8386 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8387
8388 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8389 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8390 the value returned by the target.
8391
8392 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8393 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8394 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8395 encountering a break.
8396
8397 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8398 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8399 to the debugger.
8400 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8401 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8402 request or equivalent").
8403
8404 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8405 this option (default: disabled).
8406 @end deffn
8407
8408 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8409 @cindex ARMv4
8410 @cindex ARMv5
8411
8412 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8413 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8414 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8415 variant.
8416
8417 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8418 @cindex ARM7
8419 @cindex ARM9
8420
8421 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8422 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8423 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8424 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8425
8426 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8427 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8428 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8429 instead of breakpoints.
8430 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8431
8432 This should be
8433 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8434 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8435 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8436 @end deffn
8437
8438 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8439 @cindex DCC
8440 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8441 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8442 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8443
8444 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8445 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8446 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8447 @end deffn
8448
8449 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8450 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8451 that don't check completion of the operation.
8452 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8453
8454 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8455 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8456 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8457 @end deffn
8458
8459 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8460 @cindex ARM720T
8461
8462 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8463 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8464 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8465 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8466
8467 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8468 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8469 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8470
8471 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8472 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8473 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8477 @cindex ARM9
8478
8479 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8480 integer processors.
8481 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8482
8483 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8484 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8485 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8486 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8487
8488 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8489 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8490 @cindex vector_catch
8491 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8492 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8493 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8494 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8495 to those hardware vectors.
8496
8497 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8498 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8499 vector catch hardware to intercept
8500 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8501 @option{none} of them,
8502 or a list with one or more of the following:
8503 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8504 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8505 @end deffn
8506
8507 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8508 @cindex ARM920T
8509
8510 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8511 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8512 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8513 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8514 and ARM9 commands.
8515
8516 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8517 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8518 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8519 @end deffn
8520
8521 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8522 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8523 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8524 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8525 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8526 (Not all registers can be written.)
8527 @end deffn
8528
8529 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8530 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8531 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8532
8533 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8534 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8535 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8536 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8537 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8538 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8539 @end deffn
8540
8541 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8542 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8543 @end deffn
8544
8545 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8546 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8550 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8551
8552 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8553 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8554 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8555 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8556 and ARM9 commands.
8557
8558 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8559 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8560
8561 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8562 Print information about the caches found.
8563 @end deffn
8564
8565 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8566 @cindex ARM966E
8567
8568 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8569 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8570 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8571 and ARM9 commands.
8572
8573 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8574 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8575 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8576 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8577 ARM966E-S TRM.
8578 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8579 as required for BIST support.
8580 @end deffn
8581
8582 @subsection XScale specific commands
8583 @cindex XScale
8584
8585 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8586
8587 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8588 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8589 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8590 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8591 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8592 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8593 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8594
8595 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8596 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8597 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8598 the mini-IC.
8599
8600 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8601 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8602 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8603 code layout in memory:
8604 @example
8605 _vectors:
8606 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8607 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8608 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8609 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8610 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8611 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8612 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8613 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8614 .org 0x100
8615 .long real_reset_vector
8616 .long real_ui_handler
8617 .long real_swi_handler
8618 .long real_pf_abort
8619 .long real_data_abort
8620 .long 0 /* unused */
8621 .long real_irq_handler
8622 .long real_fiq_handler
8623 @end example
8624
8625 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8626 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8627 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8628 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8629 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8630 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8631 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8632 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8633 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8634 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8635 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8636 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8637 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8638 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8639 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8640 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8641 software.
8642
8643 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8644 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8645 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8646 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8647
8648 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8649 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8650 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8651 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8652 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8653 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8654 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8655 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8656 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8657
8658 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8659 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8660
8661 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8662 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8663 @end deffn
8664
8665 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8666 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8667 @end deffn
8668
8669 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8670 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8671 @end deffn
8672
8673 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8674 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8675 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8676 @end deffn
8677
8678 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8679 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8683 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8684 @end deffn
8685
8686 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8687 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8688 @end deffn
8689
8690 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8691 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8692 @end deffn
8693
8694 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8695 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8699 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8700 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8701 and modifying how it is emptied.
8702 @end deffn
8703
8704 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8705 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8706 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8707 The image @var{type} may be one of
8708 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8709 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8710 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8714 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8715 @cindex vector_catch
8716 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8717 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8718
8719 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8720 @example
8721 0x01 Trap Reset
8722 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8723 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8724 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8725 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8726 0x20 reserved
8727 0x40 Trap IRQ
8728 0x80 Trap FIQ
8729 @end example
8730 @end deffn
8731
8732 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8733 @cindex vector_table
8734
8735 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8736 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8737 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8738 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8739 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8740
8741 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8742
8743 @end deffn
8744
8745 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8746 @cindex ARMv6
8747
8748 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8749 @cindex ARM11
8750
8751 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8752 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8753 which is enabled by default.
8754 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8755 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8756 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8757 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8758 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8759 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8760 @end deffn
8761
8762 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8763 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8764 which is enabled by default.
8765 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8766 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8767 @end deffn
8768
8769 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8770 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8771 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8772 they are disabled by default.
8773 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8774 @end deffn
8775
8776 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8777 @cindex vector_catch
8778 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8779 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8780 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8781
8782 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8783 for certain hardware events.
8784 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8785 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8786 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8787 @end deffn
8788
8789 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8790 @cindex ARMv7
8791 @cindex ARMv8
8792
8793 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8794 @cindex Cortex-A
8795
8796 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8797 display information about target caches
8798 @end deffn
8799
8800 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8801 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8802 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8803 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8804 Defaults to 'off'.
8805 @end deffn
8806
8807 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8808 Initialize core debug
8809 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8810 @end deffn
8811
8812 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8813 Disable SMP mode
8814 @end deffn
8815
8816 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8817 Enable SMP mode
8818 @end deffn
8819
8820 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8821 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8822 @end deffn
8823
8824 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8825 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8826 @end deffn
8827
8828 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8829 configure l2x cache
8830 @end deffn
8831
8832 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
8833 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
8834 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
8835 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
8836 possible (4096) entries are printed.
8837 @end deffn
8838
8839 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8840 @cindex Cortex-R
8841
8842 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8843 Initialize core debug
8844 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8845 @end deffn
8846
8847 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8848 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851
8852 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8853 @cindex tracing
8854 @cindex SWO
8855 @cindex SWV
8856 @cindex TPIU
8857 @cindex ITM
8858 @cindex ETM
8859
8860 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8861 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8862 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8863
8864 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8865 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8866 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8867 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8868
8869 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8870 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8871 debugger adapter features.
8872
8873 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8874 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8875
8876 Command options:
8877 @itemize @minus
8878 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8879 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8880 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8881 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8882 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8883 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8884 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8885 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8886 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8887 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8888 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8889 coding;
8890 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8891 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8892 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8893 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8894 data is to be output via SWO;
8895 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8896 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8897 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8898 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8899 rate automatically.
8900 @end itemize
8901
8902 Example usage:
8903 @enumerate
8904 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8905 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8906 enough to:
8907 @example
8908 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8909 ...
8910 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8911 ...
8912 @end example
8913 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8914 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8915 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8916 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8917 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8918 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8919 @example
8920 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8921 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8922 @end example
8923 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8924 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8925 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8926 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8927 @example
8928 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
8929 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8930 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8931 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8932 @end example
8933 @end enumerate
8934 @end deffn
8935
8936 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8937 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8938 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8939 @end deffn
8940
8941 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8942 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8943 @end deffn
8944
8945 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8946 @cindex Cortex-M
8947
8948 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8949 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8950
8951 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
8952 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8953 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8954 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8955 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8956 the step command leaves with the core running.
8957
8958 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
8959 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
8960 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
8961 does.
8962
8963 Default is @option{auto}.
8964 @end deffn
8965
8966 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8967 @cindex vector_catch
8968 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8969 for certain hardware events.
8970
8971 Parameters request interception of
8972 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8973 @option{none} of them,
8974 or one or more of the following:
8975 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8976 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8977 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8978 @option{irq_err},
8979 @option{state_err},
8980 @option{chk_err}, or
8981 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8982 @option{reset}.
8983 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8984 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8985 are mapped to HardFault.
8986 UsageFault checks for
8987 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8988 must also be explicitly enabled.
8989
8990 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8991 @end deffn
8992
8993 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8994 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8995 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8996 @itemize @minus
8997 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8998 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8999 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
9000 @end itemize
9001 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
9002 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9003 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
9004 the peripherals.
9005 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9006 @end deffn
9007
9008 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9009 @cindex ARMv8-A
9010 @cindex aarch64
9011
9012 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9013 Display information about target caches
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9017 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9018 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9019 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9020 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9021 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9022 @end deffn
9023
9024 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
9025 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9026 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9027 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9028 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9032 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9033 @option{on}.
9034 @end deffn
9035
9036 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9037
9038 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9039 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9040
9041 @subsection esirisc specific commands
9042 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9043 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9044 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9048 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9049 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9053 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9054 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9055 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9056 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @section Intel Architecture
9060
9061 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9062 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9063 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9064 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9065 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9066 @itemize
9067 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9068 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9069 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9070 @end itemize
9071
9072 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9073 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9074 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9075
9076 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9077 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9078 @end deffn
9079
9080 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9081 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9082 @end deffn
9083
9084 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9085 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9086 @end deffn
9087
9088 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9089 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9090 @end deffn
9091
9092 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9093 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9094 @end deffn
9095
9096 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9097 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9098 @end deffn
9099
9100 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9101
9102 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9103 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9104
9105 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9106 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9107 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9108 @end deffn
9109 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9110 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9111
9112 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9113
9114 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9115 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9116 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9117 @end deffn
9118
9119 @subsection Registers commands
9120 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9121 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9122 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9123
9124 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9125
9126 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9127 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9128 and "timer" groups.
9129
9130 @emph{example:}
9131 @example
9132 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9133 @end example
9134
9135
9136 @end deffn
9137 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9138 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9139
9140 @emph{group} can be "system",
9141 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9142 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @section RISC-V Architecture
9146
9147 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9148 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9149 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9150 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9151 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9152 implement version 0.11.
9153
9154 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9155
9156 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9157 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9158 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9159
9160 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9161
9162 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9163 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9164 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9165
9166 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9167 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9168 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9169 CSRs.
9170 @end deffn
9171
9172 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9173 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9174 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9175 @end deffn
9176
9177 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9178 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9179 deasserted.
9180 @end deffn
9181
9182 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9183 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9184 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9185 @end deffn
9186
9187 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9188 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9189 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9190 @end deffn
9191
9192 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9193
9194 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9195 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9196 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9197 @example
9198 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9199 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9200 @end example
9201
9202 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9203 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9204 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9205 @end deffn
9206
9207 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9208 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9212
9213 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9214 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9215
9216 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9217 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9218 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9219 dmi_read}.
9220 @end deffn
9221
9222 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9223 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9224 @end deffn
9225
9226 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9227 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9228 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9229 @cindex tracing
9230 @cindex libdcc
9231 @cindex DCC
9232 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9233 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9234 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9235 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9236
9237 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9238 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9239 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9240 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9241 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9242 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9243
9244 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9245 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9246 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9247 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9248 The target being debugged may
9249 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9250 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9251 each supported by a command:
9252
9253 @itemize
9254 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9255 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9256 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9257 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9258
9259 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9260 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9261 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9262
9263 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9264 and then displayed at any time.
9265 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9266
9267 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9268 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9269 @end itemize
9270
9271 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9272 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9273 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9274 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9275 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9276 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9277 does the same thing.
9278
9279 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9280 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9281 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9282 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9283 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9284
9285 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9286 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9287 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9291 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9292 in the order they triggered.
9293 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9294 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9295 history records.
9296 @end deffn
9297
9298 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9299 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9300 they have been triggered.
9301 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9302 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9303 and associates it with that identifier.
9304
9305 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9306 are not related except by this command.
9307 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9308 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9309 @end deffn
9310
9311
9312 @node JTAG Commands
9313 @chapter JTAG Commands
9314 @cindex JTAG Commands
9315 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9316 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9317 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9318 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9319 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9320
9321 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9322 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9323
9324 @itemize @bullet
9325 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9326 devices such as a CPUs.
9327 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9328 standard state machine (in parallel)
9329 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9330 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9331 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9332 while the reading previous ones.
9333 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9334 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9335 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9336 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9337 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9338 registers.
9339 @end itemize
9340
9341 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9342
9343 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9344 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9345 the order of TAP state transitions.
9346 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9347 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9348 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9349 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9350 these commands are not available.
9351
9352 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9353 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9354 that specify the entire register.
9355 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9356 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9357 The return value holds the original value of each
9358 of those fields.
9359
9360 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9361 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9362 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9363 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9364 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9365
9366 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9367 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9368
9369 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9370 in that state.
9371 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9372 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9373 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9374
9375 @quotation Warning
9376 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9377 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9378 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9379 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9380 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9381 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9382 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9383 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9384 @end quotation
9385 @end deffn
9386
9387 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9388 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9389 This may be used for performance tuning.
9390
9391 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9392 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9393 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9394 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9395 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9396 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9397 @end deffn
9398
9399 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9400 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9401 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9402 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9403 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9404 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9405
9406 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9407 in that state.
9408 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9409 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9410 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9411
9412 @quotation Note
9413 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9414 register values, unlike data register values.
9415 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9416 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9417 @end quotation
9418 @end deffn
9419
9420 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9421 Set values of reset signals.
9422 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9423 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9424 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9425 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9426 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9427 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9428 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9429
9430 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9431 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9432 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9433 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9434 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9435 instead of the TRST signal.
9436 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9437 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9438 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9439 with handlers for that event.
9440 @end deffn
9441
9442 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9443 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9444 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9445 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9446 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9447 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9448 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9449 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9450 The final state must also be stable.
9451 @end deffn
9452
9453 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9454 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9455 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9456 Instructions often need some time
9457 to execute before they take effect.
9458 @end deffn
9459
9460 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9461 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9462
9463 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9464 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9465 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9466 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9467 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9471 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9472 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9473 must also be enabled.
9474 Default is enabled.
9475 @end deffn
9476
9477 @section TAP state names
9478 @cindex TAP state names
9479
9480 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9481 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9482 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9483 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9484
9485 @itemize @bullet
9486 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9487 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9488 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9489 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9490 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9491 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9492 through the data register
9493 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9494 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9495 for update or more shifting
9496 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9497 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9498 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9499 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9500 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9501 through the instruction register
9502 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9503 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9504 for update or more shifting
9505 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9506 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9507 @end itemize
9508
9509 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9510 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9511 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9512 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9513
9514 @itemize @bullet
9515 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9516 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9517 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9518 may not be as expected.
9519 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9520 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9521 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9522 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9523 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9524 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9525 @end itemize
9526
9527 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9528 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9529
9530 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9531 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9532 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9533 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9534
9535 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9536 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9537 @cindex SVF
9538
9539 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9540 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9541 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9542 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9543
9544 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9545 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9546 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9547 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9548
9549 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9550 affect their semantics.
9551
9552 Command options:
9553 @itemize @minus
9554 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9555 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9556 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9557 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9558 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9559 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9560 on the real interface;
9561 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9562 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9563 errors.
9564 @end itemize
9565 @end deffn
9566
9567 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9568 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9569 @cindex XSVF
9570
9571 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9572 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9573 Xilinx devices.
9574 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9575 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9576
9577 @quotation Important
9578 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9579 @end quotation
9580
9581 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9582 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9583 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9584 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9585 that TAP.
9586 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9587 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9588 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9589 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9590 @end deffn
9591
9592 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9593 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9594 after building the software.
9595 You may find them useful:
9596
9597 @itemize
9598 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9599 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9600 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9601 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9602 @end itemize
9603
9604 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9605 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9606 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9607 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9608 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9609 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9610 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9611
9612
9613 @node Utility Commands
9614 @chapter Utility Commands
9615 @cindex Utility Commands
9616
9617 @section RAM testing
9618 @cindex RAM testing
9619
9620 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9621 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9622 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9623 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9624 hardware problems.
9625
9626 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9627 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9628 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9629 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9630
9631 Load the memory testing functions with
9632
9633 @example
9634 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9635 @end example
9636
9637 to get access to the following facilities:
9638
9639 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9640 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9641 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9642 @end deffn
9643
9644 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9645 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9646 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9647 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9648 @end deffn
9649
9650 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9651 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9652 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9653 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9654 @end deffn
9655
9656 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9657 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9658 @end deffn
9659
9660 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9661 @cindex Firmware recovery
9662
9663 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9664 devices recovery with JTAG.
9665
9666 For quickstart instructions run:
9667 @example
9668 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9669 @end example
9670
9671 @node TFTP
9672 @chapter TFTP
9673 @cindex TFTP
9674 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9675 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9676
9677 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9678 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9679 server (tftpd). For example,
9680
9681 @example
9682 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9683 @end example
9684
9685 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9686 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9687
9688 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9689 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9690 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9691 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9692
9693 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9694 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9695 @cindex GDB
9696 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9697 to debug remote targets.
9698 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9699
9700 @itemize
9701 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9702 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9703 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9704 as shown in this chapter.
9705 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9706 that also will probably need to be configured.
9707 @end itemize
9708
9709 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9710 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9711 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9712 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9713 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9714 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9715
9716 @section Connecting to GDB
9717 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9718 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9719 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9720 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9721 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9722
9723 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9724
9725 @enumerate
9726 @item
9727 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9728 @example
9729 target remote localhost:3333
9730 @end example
9731 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9732
9733 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9734 @example
9735 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9736 @end example
9737 @item
9738 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9739 @example
9740 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9741 @end example
9742 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9743 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9744 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9745 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9746 @end enumerate
9747
9748 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9749 GDB command line.
9750
9751 @section Sample GDB session startup
9752
9753 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9754 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9755 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9756 small ARM program.
9757 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9758 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9759
9760 @example
9761 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9762 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9763 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9764 ...
9765 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9766 ...
9767 (gdb) load
9768 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9769 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9770 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9771 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9772 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9773 (gdb) continue
9774 Continuing.
9775 ...
9776 @end example
9777
9778 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9779 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9780 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9781 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9782
9783 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9784
9785 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9786 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9787 packet size and the device's memory map.
9788 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9789 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9790 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9791
9792 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9793 You may need to set those up by hand.
9794 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9795 something like:
9796
9797 @example
9798 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9799 @end example
9800
9801 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9802
9803 @example
9804 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9805 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9806 @end example
9807
9808 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9809 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9810 do not have such restrictions.
9811
9812 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9813 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9814 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9815 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9816
9817 @section Programming using GDB
9818 @cindex Programming using GDB
9819 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9820
9821 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9822 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9823 @example
9824 gdb_memory_map disable
9825 @end example
9826 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
9827 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
9828 working area.
9829
9830 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
9831 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
9832 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
9833 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
9834
9835 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
9836 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
9837
9838 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
9839 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
9840 @example
9841 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
9842 @end example
9843
9844 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
9845 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
9846
9847 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
9848 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
9849 will be used.
9850
9851 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
9852 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
9853 @example
9854 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
9855 @end example
9856 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
9857
9858 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
9859 can be used.
9860
9861 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9862 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9863 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
9864
9865 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
9866 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
9867 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
9868
9869 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
9870 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
9871 and GDB treats it as it were running.
9872 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
9873 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
9874 without any intrusion of the target process.
9875
9876 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9877 Place following command after target configuration:
9878 @example
9879 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
9880 @end example
9881
9882 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
9883 switch off gdb_memory_map:
9884 @example
9885 gdb_memory_map disable
9886 @end example
9887
9888 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
9889 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
9890 @example
9891 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
9892 @end example
9893
9894 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
9895 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
9896
9897 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
9898 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
9899 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
9900 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
9901
9902 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
9903 previously shown varibles.
9904
9905 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
9906 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
9907 @cindex SMP
9908 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
9909 @itemize @bullet
9910 @item j - smp status request
9911 @item J - smp set request
9912 @end itemize
9913
9914 OpenOCD implements :
9915 @itemize @bullet
9916 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
9917 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
9918 @option{E01} for target not smp.
9919 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
9920 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
9921 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
9922 @end itemize
9923
9924 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
9925 @itemize @bullet
9926 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
9927 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
9928 @example
9929 set $_core 1
9930 #Jc01 packet is sent
9931 print $_core
9932 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
9933 @end example
9934
9935 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
9936 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
9937
9938 @example
9939 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
9940 define toggle0
9941 maint packet Jc0
9942 continue
9943 main packet Jc-1
9944 end
9945 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
9946 define toggle1
9947 maint packet Jc1
9948 continue
9949 main packet Jc-1
9950 end
9951 @end example
9952 @end itemize
9953
9954 @section RTOS Support
9955 @cindex RTOS Support
9956 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
9957
9958 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
9959 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
9960
9961 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
9962 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
9963 GDB commands.
9964
9965 @* An example setup is below:
9966
9967 @example
9968 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
9969 @end example
9970
9971 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
9972
9973 Currently supported rtos's include:
9974 @itemize @bullet
9975 @item @option{eCos}
9976 @item @option{ThreadX}
9977 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
9978 @item @option{linux}
9979 @item @option{ChibiOS}
9980 @item @option{embKernel}
9981 @item @option{mqx}
9982 @item @option{uCOS-III}
9983 @item @option{nuttx}
9984 @end itemize
9985
9986 @quotation Note
9987 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
9988 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
9989 @end quotation
9990
9991 @table @code
9992 @item eCos symbols
9993 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
9994 @item ThreadX symbols
9995 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
9996 @item FreeRTOS symbols
9997 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
9998 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
9999 @tex
10000 \begingroup
10001 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10002 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10003 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10004 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10005 \par
10006 \endgroup
10007 @end tex
10008 @item linux symbols
10009 init_task.
10010 @item ChibiOS symbols
10011 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10012 @item embKernel symbols
10013 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10014 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10015 @item mqx symbols
10016 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10017 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10018 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10019 @item nuttx symbols
10020 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10021 @end table
10022
10023 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10024 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10025
10026 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10027 along with the project:
10028
10029 @table @code
10030 @item FreeRTOS
10031 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10032 @item uC/OS-III
10033 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10034 @end table
10035
10036 @node Tcl Scripting API
10037 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10038 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10039 @cindex Tcl scripts
10040 @section API rules
10041
10042 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10043 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10044 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10045
10046 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10047 pair list and lists.
10048
10049 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10050 list.
10051
10052 @example
10053 > set foo(me) Duane
10054 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10055 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10056 > set foo(duck) Donald
10057 @end example
10058
10059 If one does this:
10060
10061 @example
10062 > set foo
10063 @end example
10064
10065 The result is:
10066
10067 @example
10068 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10069 @end example
10070
10071 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10072
10073 @verbatim
10074 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10075 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10076 }
10077 @end verbatim
10078
10079 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10080 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10081
10082 @section Internal low-level Commands
10083
10084 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10085 invoke directly.
10086
10087 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10088 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10089 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10090
10091 @itemize @bullet
10092 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10093
10094 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10095 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10096
10097 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10098 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10099
10100 Return information about the flash banks
10101
10102 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10103
10104 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10105 its execution. Example:
10106
10107 @example
10108 > capture "reset init"
10109 @end example
10110
10111 @end itemize
10112
10113 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10114 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10115 called "flash_banks".
10116
10117 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10118
10119 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10120 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10121 holds one of the following values:
10122
10123 @itemize @bullet
10124 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10125 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10126 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10127 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10128 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10129 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10130 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10131 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10132 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10133 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10134 @end itemize
10135
10136 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10137
10138 @quotation Note
10139 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10140 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10141 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10142 is jim, not real tcl).
10143 @end quotation
10144
10145 @section Tcl RPC server
10146 @cindex RPC
10147
10148 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10149 commands and receive the results.
10150
10151 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10152 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10153 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10154 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10155 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10156
10157 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10158 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10159 @command{capture} command.
10160
10161 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10162
10163 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10164 @cindex RPC Notifications
10165
10166 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10167 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10168
10169 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10170 in the following format.
10171
10172 @verbatim
10173 type target_event event [event-name]
10174 type target_state state [state-name]
10175 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10176 @end verbatim
10177
10178 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10179 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10180 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10181 Defaults to off.
10182
10183 @end deffn
10184
10185 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10186 @cindex RPC trace output
10187
10188 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10189 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10190
10191 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10192
10193 @verbatim
10194 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10195 @end verbatim
10196
10197 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10198 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10199 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10200 Defaults to off.
10201
10202 See an example application here:
10203 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10204
10205 @end deffn
10206
10207 @node FAQ
10208 @chapter FAQ
10209 @cindex faq
10210 @enumerate
10211 @anchor{faqrtck}
10212 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10213 @cindex RTCK
10214 @cindex adaptive clocking
10215 @*
10216
10217 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10218 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10219 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10220 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10221
10222 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10223 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10224 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10225 @enumerate
10226 @item
10227 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10228 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10229 @item
10230 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10231 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10232 @end enumerate
10233
10234 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10235 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10236 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10237 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10238 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10239 power).
10240
10241 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10242 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10243 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10244 ARM926 scenario).
10245 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10246 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10247 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10248
10249 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10250 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10251 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10252 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10253
10254 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10255
10256 In order to make use of this,
10257 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10258 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10259
10260 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10261 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10262 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10263 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10264 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10265
10266 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10267 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10268 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10269 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10270
10271 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10272 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10273 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10274 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10275 with a CPLD.
10276 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10277 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10278 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10279 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10280 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10281 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10282
10283 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10284
10285 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10286
10287 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10288 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10289 depending on the chips on your board.
10290 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10291 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10292 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10293
10294 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10295 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10296 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10297
10298 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10299 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10300 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10301 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10302
10303 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10304 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10305 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10306 this way.
10307
10308 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10309 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10310 clock rate.
10311 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10312 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10313 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10314
10315 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10316
10317 @example
10318 # Example: 1.234MHz
10319 adapter_khz 1234
10320 @end example
10321
10322
10323 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10324
10325 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10326 around Windows filenames.
10327
10328 @example
10329 > echo \a
10330
10331 > echo @{\a@}
10332 \a
10333 > echo "\a"
10334
10335 >
10336 @end example
10337
10338
10339 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10340
10341 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10342 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10343 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10344
10345 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10346 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10347 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10348
10349 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10350 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10351 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10352
10353 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10354
10355 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10356 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10357 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10358 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10359
10360 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10361 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10362 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10363
10364 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10365 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10366
10367 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10368 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10369 memory read caused data abort".
10370
10371 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10372 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10373 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10374 be done, feel free to add this here.
10375
10376 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10377 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10378 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10379 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10380 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10381 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10382 gracefully stops.
10383
10384 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10385 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10386 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10387
10388 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10389 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10390 bytes. Painful...
10391
10392
10393 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10394 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10395
10396 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10397 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10398 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10399 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10400 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10401 reset, everything else should work fine.
10402
10403 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10404 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10405 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10406 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10407
10408 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10409 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10410 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10411 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10412
10413 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10414
10415 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10416 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10417 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10418
10419 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10420 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10421
10422 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10423 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10424 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10425 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10426 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10427 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10428 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10429 clock frequency?
10430
10431 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10432 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10433 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10434 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10435 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10436
10437 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10438
10439 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10440 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10441 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10442 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10443 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10444 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10445 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10446
10447 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10448
10449 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10450 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10451 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10452 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10453
10454 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10455 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10456 particular order?
10457
10458 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10459 the same order used by the hardware.
10460
10461 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10462 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10463 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10464 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10465 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10466 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10467
10468 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10469 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10470 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10471 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10472
10473 @itemize @bullet
10474 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10475 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10476 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10477 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10478 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10479 @end itemize
10480
10481 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10482
10483 @itemize @bullet
10484 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10485 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10486 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10487 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10488 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10489 @end itemize
10490
10491
10492 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10493 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10494 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10495
10496 TODO.
10497
10498 @end enumerate
10499
10500 @node Tcl Crash Course
10501 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10502 @cindex Tcl
10503
10504 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10505 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10506 how the Tcl scripts work.
10507
10508 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10509 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10510 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10511 OpenOCD.
10512
10513 @section Tcl Rule #1
10514 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10515 @enumerate
10516 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10517 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10518 @end enumerate
10519
10520 The Tcl equal is this:
10521
10522 @enumerate
10523 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10524 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10525 @end enumerate
10526
10527 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10528 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10529
10530 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10531 There is a second pair of rules.
10532 @enumerate
10533 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10534 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10535 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10536 in Tcl.
10537 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10538 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10539 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10540 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10541 @end enumerate
10542
10543 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10544 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10545 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10546 Everything is a string}
10547
10548 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10549 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10550 difference is subtle.
10551 @enumerate
10552 @item Parse Time
10553 @item Evaluation Time
10554 @end enumerate
10555
10556 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10557 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10558 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10559
10560 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10561 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10562 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10563 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10564
10565 @itemize @bullet
10566 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10567 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10568 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10569 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10570 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10571 @example
10572 # bash example
10573 X=`date`
10574 echo "The Date is: $X"
10575 # Tcl example
10576 set X [date]
10577 puts "The Date is: $X"
10578 @end example
10579 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10580 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10581 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10582 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10583 is a string}
10584 @example
10585 set x "Dinner"
10586 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10587 @end example
10588 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10589 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10590 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10591 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10592 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10593 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10594 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10595 @end itemize
10596
10597 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10598
10599 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10600
10601 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10602
10603 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10604 the normal way.
10605
10606 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10607 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10608 line is immediately executed.
10609
10610 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10611 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10612
10613 @subsection Command Execution
10614
10615 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10616 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10617 control flow operators.
10618
10619 Commands are executed like this:
10620
10621 @enumerate
10622 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10623 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10624 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10625 @end enumerate
10626
10627 It sort of works like this:
10628 @example
10629 for(;;)@{
10630 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10631
10632 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10633
10634 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10635 @}
10636 @end example
10637
10638 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10639 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10640 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10641 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10642 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10643 ``LookupCommand()''
10644
10645 @subsection The FOR command
10646
10647 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10648 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10649 command just like any other command.
10650
10651 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10652 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10653 are:
10654
10655 @enumerate 0
10656 @item The ascii text 'for'
10657 @item The start text
10658 @item The test expression
10659 @item The next text
10660 @item The body text
10661 @end enumerate
10662
10663 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10664 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10665 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10666 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10667
10668 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10669 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10670
10671 @example
10672 int
10673 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10674 int *argc,
10675 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10676 @end example
10677
10678 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10679 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
10680 still operates in the same basic way.
10681
10682 @subsection FOR command implementation
10683
10684 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10685 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10686
10687 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10688
10689 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10690
10691 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10692 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10693 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10694
10695 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10696 expression and returns a value.
10697
10698 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10699 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10700 @example
10701 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10702
10703 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10704
10705 int
10706 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10707 int argc,
10708 char **argv )
10709 @{
10710 if( argc != 5 )@{
10711 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10712 return ERROR;
10713 @}
10714
10715 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10716
10717 // Execute the start statement.
10718 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10719
10720 // Top of loop test
10721 for(;;)@{
10722 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10723 if( i == 0 )
10724 break;
10725
10726 // Execute the body
10727 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10728
10729 // Execute the LOOP part
10730 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10731 @}
10732
10733 // Return no error
10734 SetResult( interp, "" );
10735 return SUCCESS;
10736 @}
10737 @end example
10738
10739 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10740 in the same basic way.
10741
10742 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10743
10744 @subsection source and find commands
10745 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10746 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10747 @*Remember the parsing rules
10748 @enumerate
10749 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10750 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10751 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10752 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10753 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10754 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10755 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10756 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10757 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10758 @end enumerate
10759 @subsection format command
10760 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10761 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10762 @b{sprintf()}.
10763 @b{Example}
10764 @example
10765 set x 6
10766 set y 7
10767 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10768 @end example
10769 @enumerate
10770 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10771 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10772 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10773 @* Refer to Rule #1
10774 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10775 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10776 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10777 @end enumerate
10778 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10779 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10780 @example
10781 #1 Good
10782 proc someproc @{@} @{
10783 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10784 @}
10785 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10786 #2 Good - no variables
10787 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
10788 #3 Good Curly Braces
10789 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10790 puts "Time: [date]"
10791 @}
10792 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10793 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10794 @end example
10795 @enumerate
10796 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10797 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10798 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10799 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10800 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10801 command.
10802 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10803 @*There are 4 examples:
10804 @enumerate
10805 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10806 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
10807 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10808 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10809 @end enumerate
10810
10811 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10812 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10813 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10814
10815 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10816 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10817 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10818 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10819 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10820 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10821 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10822 @end enumerate
10823 @subsection Global Variables
10824 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
10825 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
10826 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
10827 @example
10828 proc myproc @{ @} @{
10829 set y 0 #Local variable Y
10830 global x #Global variable X
10831 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
10832 @}
10833 @end example
10834 @section Other Tcl Hacks
10835 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
10836 @example
10837 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
10838 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
10839 # Create var name
10840 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
10841 # Make it a global
10842 global $vn
10843 # Set it.
10844 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
10845 @}
10846 @end example
10847 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
10848 @example
10849 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
10850 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
10851 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
10852 @}
10853 @end example
10854
10855 @include fdl.texi
10856
10857 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
10858 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
10859 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
10860 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
10861 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
10862 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
10863
10864 @printindex cp
10865
10866 @node Command and Driver Index
10867 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
10868 @printindex fn
10869
10870 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)